3 @setfilename coreutils.info
5 @settitle GNU Coreutils @value{VERSION}
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @set txicodequoteundirected
8 @set txicodequotebacktick
13 @include constants.texi
15 @c Define new indices.
19 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
29 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
30 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options.
31 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
32 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
35 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
36 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
37 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
39 @dircategory Individual utilities
41 * arch: (coreutils)arch invocation. Print machine hardware name.
42 * b2sum: (coreutils)b2sum invocation. Print or check BLAKE2 digests.
43 * base32: (coreutils)base32 invocation. Base32 encode/decode data.
44 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
45 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
46 * basenc: (coreutils)basenc invocation. Encoding/decoding of data.
47 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
48 * chcon: (coreutils)chcon invocation. Change SELinux CTX of files.
49 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
50 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change access permissions.
51 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners and groups.
52 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
53 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
54 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
55 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
56 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
57 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
58 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
59 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
60 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system usage.
61 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
62 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
63 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip last file name component.
64 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report file usage.
65 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
66 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
67 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
68 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
69 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
70 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
71 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
72 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
73 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
74 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
75 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
76 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
77 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
78 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy files and set attributes.
79 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
80 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
81 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
82 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
83 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
84 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
85 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
86 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
87 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
88 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
89 * mktemp: (coreutils)mktemp invocation. Create temporary files.
90 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
91 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
92 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
93 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
94 * nproc: (coreutils)nproc invocation. Print the number of processors.
95 * numfmt: (coreutils)numfmt invocation. Reformat numbers.
96 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
97 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
98 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
99 * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. Print information about users.
100 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
101 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
102 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
103 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
104 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
105 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
106 * realpath: (coreutils)realpath invocation. Print resolved file names.
107 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
108 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
109 * runcon: (coreutils)runcon invocation. Run in specified SELinux CTX.
110 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
111 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
112 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
113 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
114 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
115 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
116 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
117 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into pieces.
118 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
119 * stdbuf: (coreutils)stdbuf invocation. Modify stdio buffering.
120 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
121 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
122 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Sync files to stable storage.
123 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
124 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
125 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
126 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
127 * timeout: (coreutils)timeout invocation. Run with time limit.
128 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
129 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
130 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
131 * truncate: (coreutils)truncate invocation. Shrink/extend size of a file.
132 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
133 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
134 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
135 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
136 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
137 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
138 * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. Print uptime and load.
139 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
140 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
141 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
142 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
143 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
144 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
148 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the GNU core
149 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
151 Copyright @copyright{} 1994--2024 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
154 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
155 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
156 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
157 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
158 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
159 Free Documentation License''.
164 @title GNU @code{Coreutils}
165 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
166 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
167 @author David MacKenzie et al.
170 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
183 @cindex core utilities
184 @cindex text utilities
185 @cindex shell utilities
186 @cindex file utilities
189 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors
190 * Common options:: Common options
191 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od base32 base64 basenc
192 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
193 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
194 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum b2sum md5sum sha1sum sha2
195 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
196 * Operating on fields:: cut paste join
197 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
198 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
199 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
200 * Special file types:: mkdir rmdir unlink mkfifo mknod ln link readlink
201 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
202 * File space usage:: df du stat sync truncate
203 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
204 * Conditions:: false true test expr
206 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk mktemp realpath
207 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
208 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
209 * System context:: date arch nproc uname hostname hostid uptime
210 * SELinux context:: chcon runcon
211 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup stdbuf timeout
212 * Process control:: kill
214 * Numeric operations:: factor numfmt seq
215 * File permissions:: Access modes
216 * File timestamps:: File timestamp issues
217 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
218 * Version sort ordering:: Details on version-sort algorithm
219 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy
220 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
221 * Concept index:: General index
224 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
228 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure
229 * Backup options:: Backup options
230 * Block size:: Block size
231 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation
232 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals
233 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
234 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
235 * Target directory:: Target directory
236 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
237 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
238 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
239 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
240 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation
242 Output of entire files
244 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files
245 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse
246 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files
247 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats
248 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
249 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
250 * basenc invocation:: Transform data into printable data
252 Formatting file contents
254 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text
255 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing
256 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
258 Output of parts of files
260 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files
261 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files
262 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
263 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces
267 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts
268 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts
269 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
270 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests
271 * b2sum invocation:: Print or check BLAKE2 digests
272 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests
273 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests
275 Operating on sorted files
277 * sort invocation:: Sort text files
278 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files
279 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files
280 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line
281 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents
282 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort
284 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
286 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior
287 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations
288 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection
289 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields
290 * Compatibility in ptx:: The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
294 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines
295 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files
296 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field
298 Operating on characters
300 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
301 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces
302 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs
304 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
306 * Character arrays:: Specifying arrays of characters
307 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another
308 * Squeezing and deleting:: Removing characters
312 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
313 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
314 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
315 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
317 @command{ls}: List directory contents
319 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
320 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
321 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
322 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
323 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
327 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
328 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
329 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
330 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
331 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
332 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
336 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
337 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
338 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
339 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
340 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
341 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
342 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
343 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
345 Changing file attributes
347 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
348 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
349 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
350 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
354 * df invocation:: Report file system space usage
355 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
356 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
357 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
358 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file
362 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
363 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
364 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
368 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
369 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
370 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
371 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
373 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
375 * File type tests:: File type tests
376 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
377 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
378 * String tests:: String tests
379 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
381 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
383 * String expressions:: @code{+ : match substr index length}
384 * Numeric expressions:: @code{+ - * / %}
385 * Relations for expr:: @code{| & < <= = == != >= >}
386 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
390 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
392 File name manipulation
394 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
395 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component
396 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability
397 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory
398 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names
402 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
403 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
404 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
405 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
407 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
409 * Control:: Control settings
410 * Input:: Input settings
411 * Output:: Output settings
412 * Local:: Local settings
413 * Combination:: Combination settings
414 * Characters:: Special characters
415 * Special:: Special settings
419 * id invocation:: Print user identity
420 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
421 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
422 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
423 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
424 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
425 * pinky invocation:: Print information about users
429 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name
430 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
431 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors
432 * uname invocation:: Print system information
433 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
434 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier
435 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load
437 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
439 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
440 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
441 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
442 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
443 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock
444 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time
445 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
446 * Examples of date:: Examples
450 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
451 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
453 Modified command invocation
455 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
456 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
457 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
458 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
459 * stdbuf invocation:: Run a command with modified I/O buffering
460 * timeout invocation:: Run a command with a time limit
464 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
468 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
472 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
473 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers
474 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
479 * File timestamps:: File timestamp issues
483 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits
484 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits
485 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers
486 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories
490 * General date syntax:: Common rules
491 * Calendar date items:: @samp{14 Nov 2022}
492 * Time of day items:: @samp{9:02pm}
493 * Time zone items:: @samp{UTC}, @samp{-0700}, @samp{+0900}, @dots{}
494 * Combined date and time of day items:: @samp{2022-11-14T21:02:42,000000-0500}
495 * Day of week items:: @samp{Monday} and others
496 * Relative items in date strings:: @samp{next tuesday, 2 years ago}
497 * Pure numbers in date strings:: @samp{20221114}, @samp{2102}
498 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @samp{@@1668477762}
499 * Specifying time zone rules:: @samp{TZ="America/New_York"}, @samp{TZ="UTC0"}
500 * Authors of parse_datetime:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al.
502 Version sorting order
504 * Version sort overview::
505 * Version sort implementation::
506 * Differences from Debian version sort::
507 * Advanced version sort topics::
509 Opening the software toolbox
511 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
512 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
513 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
514 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
515 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
516 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
517 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
521 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
528 @chapter Introduction
530 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
531 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
532 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire GNU community
536 The GNU utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
538 @cindex bugs, reporting
540 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}.
541 Include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
542 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
543 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong.
545 If you have a problem with @command{sort} or @command{date}, try using the
546 @option{--debug} option, as it can often help find and fix problems without
547 having to wait for an answer to a bug report. If the debug output
548 does not suffice to fix the problem on your own, please compress and
549 attach it to the rest of your bug report.
551 Although diffs are welcome,
552 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
553 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
559 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
562 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
563 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
564 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
565 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
566 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
567 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
568 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
569 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
570 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
571 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
572 insights to the overall process.
575 @chapter Common options
579 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
582 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
583 @cindex backups, making
584 @xref{Backup options}.
585 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
588 @macro optBackupSuffix
589 @item -S @var{suffix}
590 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
593 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
594 @xref{Backup options}.
597 @macro optTargetDirectory
598 @item -t @var{directory}
599 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
601 @opindex --target-directory
602 @cindex target directory
603 @cindex destination directory
604 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
605 @xref{Target directory}.
608 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
610 @itemx --no-target-directory
612 @opindex --no-target-directory
613 @cindex target directory
614 @cindex destination directory
615 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
616 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
620 @cindex output NUL-byte-terminated lines
621 Output a zero byte (ASCII NUL) at the end of each line,
622 rather than a newline. This option enables other programs to parse the
623 output even when that output would contain data with embedded newlines.
642 @macro optZeroTerminated
644 @itemx --zero-terminated
646 @opindex --zero-terminated
647 @cindex process zero-terminated items
648 Delimit items with a zero byte rather than a newline (ASCII LF).
649 I.e., treat input as items separated by ASCII NUL
650 and terminate output items with ASCII NUL.
651 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
652 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
653 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
654 or other special characters).
661 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
662 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
663 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
664 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
665 @option{--human-readable} option if
666 you prefer powers of 1024.
669 @macro optHumanReadable
671 @itemx --human-readable
673 @opindex --human-readable
674 @cindex human-readable output
675 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
676 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
677 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
678 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
681 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
682 @item --strip-trailing-slashes
683 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
684 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
685 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
686 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
689 @macro mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{cmd}
690 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
691 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
692 Due to shell aliases and built-in @command{\cmd\} functions, using an
693 unadorned @command{\cmd\} interactively or in a script may get you
694 different functionality than that described here. Invoke it via
695 @command{env} (i.e., @code{env \cmd\ @dots{}}) to avoid interference
700 @macro multiplierSuffixes{varName}
701 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
702 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
704 @samp{b} => 512 ("blocks")
705 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
706 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
707 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
708 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
709 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
710 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
712 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, @samp{Y},
713 @samp{R}, and @samp{Q}.
714 Binary prefixes can be used, too: @samp{KiB}=@samp{K}, @samp{MiB}=@samp{M},
718 @c FIXME: same as above, but no ``blocks'' line.
719 @macro multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{varName}
720 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
721 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
723 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
724 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
725 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
726 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
727 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
728 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
730 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, @samp{Y},
731 @samp{R}, and @samp{Q}.
732 Binary prefixes can be used, too: @samp{KiB}=@samp{K}, @samp{MiB}=@samp{M},
736 @cindex common options
738 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
739 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
740 described here. (In fact, every GNU program accepts (or should accept)
743 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
744 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
745 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
746 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
747 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
748 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
749 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
751 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
752 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
753 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
754 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
755 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
756 specify a command that itself contains options.
758 Most programs that accept long options recognize unambiguous
759 abbreviations of those options. For example, @samp{rmdir
760 --ignore-fail-on-non-empty} can be invoked as @samp{rmdir
761 --ignore-fail} or even @samp{rmdir --i}. Ambiguous options, such as
762 @samp{ls --h}, are identified as such.
764 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
765 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument. For
766 these programs, abbreviations of the long options are not always recognized.
773 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
777 @cindex version number, finding
778 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
782 @cindex option delimiter
783 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
784 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
785 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
789 @cindex standard input
790 @cindex standard output
791 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
792 stands for a file operand, and some tools treat it as standard input, or as
793 standard output if that is clear from the context. For example, @samp{sort -}
794 reads from standard input, and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}. Unless
795 otherwise specified, a @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
799 Items shared between some programs:
801 * Backup options:: @option{-b} @option{-S}.
802 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and @option{--block-size}.
803 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals with @option{--signal}.
804 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
805 * Random sources:: @option{--random-source}.
806 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory.
807 * Trailing slashes:: @option{--strip-trailing-slashes}.
808 * Traversing symlinks:: @option{-H}, @option{-L}, or @option{-P}.
809 * Treating / specially:: @option{--preserve-root} and the converse.
810 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @dots{}
812 Items applicable to all programs:
814 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
815 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation.
816 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the POSIX standard.
817 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation.
822 @section Backup options
824 @cindex backup options
826 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
827 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
828 before writing new versions.
829 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
830 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
835 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
838 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
839 @cindex backups, making
840 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
841 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
842 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
843 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
844 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
845 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
846 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
848 Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing};
849 @option{-b} does not accept any argument.
851 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
852 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
853 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
854 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
855 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
860 @opindex none @r{backup method}
865 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
866 Always make numbered backups.
870 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
871 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
876 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
877 Always make simple backups. Do not confuse @samp{never} with @samp{none}.
881 @item -S @var{suffix}
882 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
885 @cindex backup suffix
886 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
887 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
888 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
889 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
890 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
899 Some GNU programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
900 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
901 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
902 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
903 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
905 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
908 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
909 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
910 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
911 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
913 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
914 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
919 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
920 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
921 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
924 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
925 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
928 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
929 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
930 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
931 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
932 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
935 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
936 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
937 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
942 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
943 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
944 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
947 @cindex human-readable output
950 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
951 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
952 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
953 that are upward compatible with the
954 @uref{http://www.bipm.org/en/publications/si-brochure/chapter3.html,
956 for decimal multiples and with the
957 @uref{https://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, ISO/IEC 80000-13
958 (formerly IEC 60027-2) prefixes} for binary multiples.
960 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
961 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
962 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
963 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
964 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
967 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
968 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
969 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
970 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
971 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
972 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
975 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
976 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
977 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
978 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
979 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
980 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
981 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
983 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
984 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
985 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
988 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Q}
989 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
993 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
994 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
998 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
999 kibibyte: @math{2^{10} = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
1000 @samp{k} and the ISO/IEC 80000-13 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
1001 POSIX use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
1003 @cindex megabyte, definition of
1004 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
1007 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
1008 mebibyte: @math{2^{20} = 1,048,576}.
1010 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
1011 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
1014 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
1015 gibibyte: @math{2^{30} = 1,073,741,824}.
1017 @cindex terabyte, definition of
1018 terabyte: @math{10^{12} = 1,000,000,000,000}.
1021 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
1022 tebibyte: @math{2^{40} = 1,099,511,627,776}.
1024 @cindex petabyte, definition of
1025 petabyte: @math{10^{15} = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
1028 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
1029 pebibyte: @math{2^{50} = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
1031 @cindex exabyte, definition of
1032 exabyte: @math{10^{18} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1035 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
1036 exbibyte: @math{2^{60} = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
1038 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
1039 zettabyte: @math{10^{21} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
1042 zebibyte: @math{2^{70} = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
1044 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
1045 yottabyte: @math{10^{24} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1048 yobibyte: @math{2^{80} = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
1050 @cindex ronnabyte, definition of
1051 ronnabyte: @math{10^{27} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1054 robibyte: @math{2^{90} = 1,237,940,039,285,380,274,899,124,224}.
1056 @cindex quettabyte, definition of
1057 quettabyte: @math{10^{30} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1060 quebibyte: @math{2^{100} = 1,267,650,600,228,229,401,496,703,205,376}.
1065 @opindex --block-size
1066 @opindex --human-readable
1069 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
1070 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
1071 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
1072 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
1073 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
1074 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
1075 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}. Note for @command{ls}
1076 the @option{-k} option does not control the display of the
1077 apparent file sizes, whereas the @option{--block-size} option does.
1079 @node Signal specifications
1080 @section Signal specifications
1081 @cindex signals, specifying
1083 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
1084 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
1085 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
1086 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored. The following signal names
1087 and numbers are supported on all POSIX compliant systems:
1093 2. Terminal interrupt.
1099 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
1107 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
1108 numbers. All systems conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001 also
1109 support the following signals:
1113 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
1115 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
1117 Continue executing, if stopped.
1119 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
1121 Illegal Instruction.
1123 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
1125 Invalid memory reference.
1127 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
1131 Background process attempting read.
1133 Background process attempting write.
1135 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
1137 User-defined signal 1.
1139 User-defined signal 2.
1143 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XSI extension
1144 also support the following signals:
1150 Profiling timer expired.
1154 Trace/breakpoint trap.
1156 Virtual timer expired.
1158 CPU time limit exceeded.
1160 File size limit exceeded.
1164 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XRT extension
1165 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
1166 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
1168 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
1169 @section chown, chgrp, chroot, id: Disambiguating user names and IDs
1170 @cindex user names, disambiguating
1171 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
1172 @cindex group names, disambiguating
1173 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
1174 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
1176 Since the @var{user} and @var{group} arguments to these commands
1177 may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
1179 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
1180 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID@?
1181 (Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.)
1182 POSIX requires that these commands
1183 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
1184 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID@.
1185 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
1186 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
1187 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
1188 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
1189 1000 -- not what you intended.
1191 GNU @command{chown}, @command{chgrp}, @command{chroot}, and @command{id}
1192 provide a way to work around this, that at the same time may result in a
1193 significant performance improvement by eliminating a database look-up.
1194 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
1195 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
1199 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
1203 The name look-up process is skipped for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
1204 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
1205 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
1207 @node Random sources
1208 @section Sources of random data
1210 @cindex random sources
1212 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
1213 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
1214 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
1215 make this selection.
1217 By default these commands use an internal pseudo-random generator
1218 initialized by a small amount of entropy, but can be directed to use
1219 an external source with the @option{--random-source=@var{file}} option.
1220 An error is reported if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes.
1222 For example, the device file @file{/dev/urandom} could be used as the
1223 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
1224 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
1225 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
1226 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
1227 cryptographically secure pseudo-random number generator. But be aware
1228 that this device is not designed for bulk random data generation
1229 and is relatively slow.
1231 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
1232 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
1233 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
1234 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
1237 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
1238 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1239 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1241 Rather than depending on a file, one can generate a reproducible
1242 arbitrary amount of pseudo-random data given a seed value, using
1249 openssl enc -aes-256-ctr -pass pass:"$seed" -nosalt \
1250 </dev/zero 2>/dev/null
1253 shuf -i1-100 --random-source=<(get_seeded_random 42)
1256 @node Target directory
1257 @section Target directory
1259 @cindex target directory
1261 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1262 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1263 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1264 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1265 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1266 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1267 allow more fine-grained control:
1272 @itemx --no-target-directory
1273 @opindex --no-target-directory
1274 @cindex target directory
1275 @cindex destination directory
1276 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1277 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1278 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1279 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1280 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1281 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1282 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1283 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1284 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1286 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1287 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1288 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1290 @item -t @var{directory}
1291 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
1292 @opindex --target-directory
1293 @cindex target directory
1294 @cindex destination directory
1295 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1298 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1299 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1300 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1301 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1302 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1304 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1305 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1306 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1307 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1308 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1309 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1310 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1311 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1314 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1315 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1316 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1317 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1320 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1323 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1324 If you use the GNU @command{find} program, you can move those
1325 files too, with this command:
1328 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1332 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1333 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1334 some other special characters.
1335 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1336 GNU @command{find} and GNU @command{xargs}:
1339 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1340 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1347 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1348 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1349 options cannot be combined.
1351 @node Trailing slashes
1352 @section Trailing slashes
1354 @cindex trailing slashes
1356 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1357 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1358 operating on it. The @option{--strip-trailing-slashes} option enables
1361 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1362 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1363 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1364 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1365 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1366 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1367 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1368 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1369 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1370 be the default, it is required by POSIX and is consistent with
1371 other parts of that standard.
1373 @node Traversing symlinks
1374 @section Traversing symlinks
1376 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1378 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1379 @c FIXME: note that 'du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1380 @c different meaning.
1381 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1382 option is also specified.
1383 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1385 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1386 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1387 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1389 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1390 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1391 a symlink or its referent.
1398 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse if on the command line
1399 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1400 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1407 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1408 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1409 that is encountered.
1412 @c Append the following warning to -L where appropriate (e.g. chown).
1413 @macro warnOptDerefWithRec
1415 Combining this dereferencing option with the @option{--recursive} option
1416 may create a security risk:
1417 During the traversal of the directory tree, an attacker may be able to
1418 introduce a symlink to an arbitrary target; when the tool reaches that,
1419 the operation will be performed on the target of that symlink,
1420 possibly allowing the attacker to escalate privileges.
1429 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1430 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1431 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1432 or @option{-P} is specified.
1439 @node Treating / specially
1440 @section Treating @file{/} specially
1442 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1443 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1444 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1445 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1446 legitimate uses for such a command,
1447 GNU @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1448 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1449 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1450 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1451 @option{--preserve-root} option, is safer for most purposes.
1453 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1454 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1455 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1456 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1457 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1458 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1459 interrupt them. Tradition and POSIX require these commands
1460 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1461 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1462 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1463 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1465 The @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1466 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1467 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1469 @node Special built-in utilities
1470 @section Special built-in utilities
1472 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1473 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1474 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1475 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1476 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1477 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1480 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1481 by POSIX 1003.1-2004.
1484 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1485 return set shift times trap unset}
1488 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1489 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1490 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1492 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1493 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1494 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1495 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1499 @section Exit status
1502 An exit status of zero indicates success,
1503 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
1506 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
1507 that can be used to change how other commands work.
1508 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
1509 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value -- typically
1510 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as POSIX
1511 requires only that it be nonzero.
1513 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
1514 other exit status values and a few associate different
1515 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
1516 Here are the exceptions:
1517 @c You can generate the following list with:
1518 @c grep initialize_exit_failure src/*.c | cut -f1 -d: |
1519 @c sed -n 's|src/\(.*\)\.c|@command{\1},|p' | sort | fmt
1520 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr}, @command{ls},
1521 @command{nice}, @command{nohup}, @command{numfmt}, @command{printenv},
1522 @command{runcon}, @command{sort}, @command{stdbuf}, @command{test},
1523 @command{timeout}, @command{tty}.
1525 @node Floating point
1526 @section Floating point numbers
1527 @cindex floating point
1528 @cindex IEEE floating point
1530 Commands that accept or produce floating point numbers employ the
1531 floating point representation of the underlying system, and suffer
1532 from rounding error, overflow, and similar floating-point issues.
1533 Almost all modern systems use IEEE-754 floating point, and it is
1534 typically portable to assume IEEE-754 behavior these days. IEEE-754
1535 has positive and negative infinity, distinguishes positive from
1536 negative zero, and uses special values called NaNs to represent
1537 invalid computations such as dividing zero by itself. For more
1538 information, please see David Goldberg's paper
1539 @uref{https://@/docs.oracle.com/@/cd/@/E19957-01/@/806-3568/@/ncg_goldberg.html,
1540 What Every Computer Scientist Should Know About Floating-Point Arithmetic}.
1542 Commands that accept floating point numbers as options, operands or
1543 input use the standard C functions @code{strtod} and @code{strtold} to
1544 convert from text to floating point numbers. These floating point
1545 numbers therefore can use scientific notation like @code{1.0e-34} and
1546 @code{-10e100}. Commands that parse floating point also understand
1547 case-insensitive @code{inf}, @code{infinity}, and @code{NaN}, although
1548 whether such values are useful depends on the command in question.
1549 Modern C implementations also accept hexadecimal floating point
1550 numbers such as @code{-0x.ep-3}, which stands for @minus{}14/16 times
1551 @math{2^-3}, which equals @minus{}0.109375. @xref{Parsing of
1552 Floats,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
1555 Normally the @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale determines the decimal-point
1556 character. However, some commands' descriptions specify that they
1557 accept numbers in either the current or the C locale; for example,
1558 they treat @samp{3.14} like @samp{3,14} if the current locale uses
1559 comma as a decimal point.
1562 @node Standards conformance
1563 @section Standards conformance
1565 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1566 In a few cases, the GNU utilities' default behavior is
1567 incompatible with the POSIX standard. To suppress these
1568 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1569 variable. Unless you are checking for POSIX conformance, you
1570 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1572 Newer versions of POSIX are occasionally incompatible with older
1573 versions. For example, older versions of POSIX required the
1574 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1575 fields in each input line, but in POSIX 1003.1-2001
1576 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1577 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1578 sort. To complicate things further, POSIX 1003.1-2008 allows an
1579 implementation to have either the old or the new behavior.
1581 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1582 The GNU utilities normally conform to the version of POSIX
1583 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1584 different version of POSIX, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1585 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1586 the year and month the standard was adopted. Three values are currently
1587 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1588 POSIX 1003.2-1992, @samp{200112} stands for POSIX
1589 1003.1-2001, and @samp{200809} stands for POSIX 1003.1-2008.
1590 For example, if you have a POSIX 1003.1-2001 system but are running software
1591 containing traditional usage like @samp{sort +1} or @samp{tail +10},
1592 you can work around the compatibility problems by setting
1593 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=200809} in your environment.
1595 @c This node is named "Multi-call invocation", not the usual
1596 @c "coreutils invocation", so that shell commands like
1597 @c 'info coreutils "touch invocation"' work as expected.
1598 @node Multi-call invocation
1599 @section @command{coreutils}: Multi-call program
1603 @cindex calling combined multi-call program
1605 The @command{coreutils} command invokes an individual utility, either
1606 implicitly selected by the last component of the name used to invoke
1607 @command{coreutils}, or explicitly with the
1608 @option{--coreutils-prog} option. Synopsis:
1611 coreutils @option{--coreutils-prog=PROGRAM} @dots{}
1614 The @command{coreutils} command is not installed by default, so
1615 portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
1617 @node Output of entire files
1618 @chapter Output of entire files
1620 @cindex output of entire files
1621 @cindex entire files, output of
1623 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1627 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1628 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1629 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1630 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1631 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1632 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1633 * basenc invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1636 @node cat invocation
1637 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1640 @cindex concatenate and write files
1641 @cindex copying files
1643 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1644 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1647 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1650 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1658 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1661 @itemx --number-nonblank
1663 @opindex --number-nonblank
1664 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1668 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1673 @opindex --show-ends
1674 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1675 The @code{\r\n} combination is shown as @samp{^M$}.
1681 Number all output lines, starting with 1. This option is ignored
1682 if @option{-b} is in effect.
1685 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1687 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1688 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1689 @cindex squeezing blank lines
1690 Suppress repeated adjacent blank lines; output just one empty line
1695 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1700 @opindex --show-tabs
1701 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1705 Ignored; for POSIX compatibility.
1708 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1710 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1711 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1712 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1717 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1718 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1719 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1720 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1721 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1722 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1723 if standard output is a terminal.
1730 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1733 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1738 @node tac invocation
1739 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1742 @cindex reversing files
1744 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1745 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1746 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1749 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1752 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1753 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1754 the record that it follows in the file.
1756 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1764 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1765 precedes in the file.
1771 Treat the separator string as a regular expression.
1773 @item -s @var{separator}
1774 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1776 @opindex --separator
1777 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1778 Note an empty @var{separator} is treated as a zero byte.
1779 I.e., input and output items are delimited with ASCII NUL.
1783 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1784 @command{tac} reads and writes in binary mode.
1791 # Reverse a file character by character.
1797 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1800 @cindex numbering lines
1801 @cindex line numbering
1803 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1804 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1805 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1808 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1811 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1812 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) page sections;
1813 by default, the line number is reset to 1 at each logical page section.
1814 @command{nl} treats all of the input files as a single document;
1815 it does not reset line numbers or logical pages between files.
1817 @cindex headers, numbering
1818 @cindex body, numbering
1819 @cindex footers, numbering
1820 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1821 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1822 style from the others.
1824 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1825 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1836 The characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1837 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern
1838 of each string cannot be changed.
1840 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1841 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1842 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1843 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1845 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1849 @item -b @var{style}
1850 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1852 @opindex --body-numbering
1853 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1854 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1855 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1856 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1862 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1864 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1866 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1867 expression @var{bre}.
1868 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1872 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1874 @opindex --section-delimiter
1875 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1876 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1877 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1878 As a GNU extension more than two characters can be specified,
1879 and also if @var{cd} is empty (@option{-d ''}), then section
1880 matching is disabled.
1881 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1882 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1884 @item -f @var{style}
1885 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1887 @opindex --footer-numbering
1888 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1890 @item -h @var{style}
1891 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1893 @opindex --header-numbering
1894 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1896 @item -i @var{number}
1897 @itemx --line-increment=@var{number}
1899 @opindex --line-increment
1900 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1901 @var{number} can be negative to decrement.
1903 @item -l @var{number}
1904 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1906 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1907 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1908 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1909 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1910 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1911 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1912 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1915 @item -n @var{format}
1916 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1918 @opindex --number-format
1919 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1923 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1924 left justified, no leading zeros;
1926 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1927 right justified, no leading zeros;
1929 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1930 right justified, leading zeros.
1934 @itemx --no-renumber
1936 @opindex --no-renumber
1937 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1939 @item -s @var{string}
1940 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1942 @opindex --number-separator
1943 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1944 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1946 @item -v @var{number}
1947 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1949 @opindex --starting-line-number
1950 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1951 The starting @var{number} can be negative.
1953 @item -w @var{number}
1954 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1956 @opindex --number-width
1957 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1965 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1968 @cindex octal dump of files
1969 @cindex hex dump of files
1970 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1971 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1973 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1974 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1978 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1979 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1980 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}]@c
1981 [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1984 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1985 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1986 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1987 printed as a single octal number.
1989 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1990 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1991 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1992 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1993 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1994 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1995 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1997 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1998 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1999 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
2000 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
2003 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2007 @item -A @var{radix}
2008 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
2010 @opindex --address-radix
2011 @cindex radix for file offsets
2012 @cindex file offset radix
2013 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
2014 be one of the following:
2024 none (do not print offsets).
2027 The default is octal.
2029 @item --endian=@var{order}
2031 @cindex byte-swapping
2033 Reorder input bytes, to handle inputs with differing byte orders,
2034 or to provide consistent output independent of the endian convention
2035 of the current system. Swapping is performed according to the
2036 specified @option{--type} size and endian @var{order}, which can be
2037 @samp{little} or @samp{big}.
2039 @item -j @var{bytes}
2040 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
2042 @opindex --skip-bytes
2043 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
2044 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
2045 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
2047 @multiplierSuffixes{bytes}
2049 @item -N @var{bytes}
2050 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
2052 @opindex --read-bytes
2053 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
2054 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
2056 @item -S @var{bytes}
2057 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
2060 @cindex string constants, outputting
2061 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
2062 least @var{bytes} consecutive printable characters,
2063 followed by a zero byte (ASCII NUL).
2064 Prefixes and suffixes on @var{bytes} are interpreted as for the
2067 If @var{bytes} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
2070 @itemx --format=@var{type}
2073 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
2074 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
2075 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
2076 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
2077 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
2078 in the order that you specified.
2080 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
2081 of the single byte character representation of the printable characters
2082 to the output line generated by the type specification.
2086 named character, ignoring high-order bit
2088 printable single byte character, C backslash escape
2089 or a 3 digit octal sequence
2093 floating point (@pxref{Floating point})
2102 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
2103 newline, and @samp{nul} for a zero byte. Only the least significant
2104 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
2105 Type @code{c} outputs
2106 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
2109 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
2110 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
2111 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
2112 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
2113 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
2114 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
2115 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
2128 For floating point (@code{f}):
2132 @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Bfloat16_floating-point_format,
2135 @uref{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Half-precision_floating-point_format,
2136 half precision float}
2146 @itemx --output-duplicates
2148 @opindex --output-duplicates
2149 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
2150 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
2151 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
2152 indicate the elision.
2155 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
2158 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
2159 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
2162 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
2163 omitted, the default is 32.
2167 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
2168 GNU @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
2169 specification options. These options accumulate.
2175 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
2179 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
2183 Output as printable single byte characters, C backslash escapes
2184 or 3 digit octal sequences. Equivalent to @samp{-t c}.
2188 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
2192 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
2196 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
2200 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
2204 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
2208 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
2212 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
2215 @opindex --traditional
2216 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
2217 accepted. The following syntax:
2220 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
2224 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
2225 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
2226 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
2227 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
2228 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
2236 @node base32 invocation
2237 @section @command{base32}: Transform data into printable data
2240 @cindex base32 encoding
2242 @command{base32} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2243 into (or from) base32 encoded form. The base32 encoded form uses
2244 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2245 The usage and options of this command are precisely the
2246 same as for @command{base64}. @xref{base64 invocation}.
2247 For more general encoding functionality see @ref{basenc invocation}.
2250 @node base64 invocation
2251 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data
2254 @cindex base64 encoding
2256 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2257 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
2258 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2262 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2263 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2266 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
2267 The base32 encoding expands data to roughly 160% of the original.
2268 The format conforms to
2269 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc4648/, RFC 4648}.
2271 For more general encoding functionality see @ref{basenc invocation}.
2273 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2278 @itemx --wrap=@var{cols}
2282 @cindex column to wrap data after
2283 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{cols} characters. This must be
2286 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
2287 disable line wrapping altogether.
2293 @cindex Decode base64 data
2294 @cindex Base64 decoding
2295 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
2296 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
2297 output will be the original data.
2300 @itemx --ignore-garbage
2302 @opindex --ignore-garbage
2303 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
2304 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
2305 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
2306 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
2312 @node basenc invocation
2313 @section @command{basenc}: Transform data into printable data
2316 @cindex base32 encoding
2318 @command{basenc} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2319 into (or from) various common encoding forms. The encoded form uses
2320 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2325 basenc @var{encoding} [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2326 basenc @var{encoding} --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2329 The @var{encoding} argument is required. If @var{file} is omitted,
2330 @command{basenc} reads from standard input.
2331 The @option{-w/--wrap},@option{-i/--ignore-garbage},
2332 @option{-d/--decode} options of this command are precisely the same as
2333 for @command{base64}. @xref{base64 invocation}.
2336 Supported @var{encoding}s are:
2342 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) base64 form.
2343 The format conforms to
2344 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-4, RFC 4648#4}.
2345 Equivalent to the @command{base64} command.
2348 @opindex --base64url
2349 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) file-and-url-safe
2350 base64 form (using @samp{_} and @samp{-} instead of @samp{+} and @samp{/}).
2351 The format conforms to
2352 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-5, RFC 4648#5}.
2356 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) base32 form.
2357 The encoded data uses the @samp{ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ234567=} characters.
2358 The format conforms to
2359 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-6, RFC 4648#6}.
2360 Equivalent to the @command{base32} command.
2363 @opindex --base32hex
2364 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) Extended Hex Alphabet
2365 base32 form. The encoded data uses the
2366 @samp{0123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV=} characters. The format conforms to
2367 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-7, RFC 4648#7}.
2371 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) base16 (hexadecimal)
2372 form. The encoded data uses the @samp{0123456789ABCDEF} characters. The format
2374 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-8, RFC 4648#8}.
2377 @opindex --base2lsbf
2378 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) binary string form
2379 (@samp{0} and @samp{1}) with the @emph{least} significant bit of every byte
2383 @opindex --base2msbf
2384 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) binary string form
2385 (@samp{0} and @samp{1}) with the @emph{most} significant bit of every byte
2390 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) Z85 form
2391 (a modified Ascii85 form). The encoded data uses the
2392 @samp{0123456789abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTU@
2393 VWXYZ.-:+=^!/*?&<>()[]@{@}@@%$#}.
2394 characters. The format conforms to
2395 @uref{https://rfc.zeromq.org/spec:32/Z85/, ZeroMQ spec:32/Z85}.
2397 When encoding with @option{--z85}, input length must be a multiple of 4;
2398 when decoding with @option{--z85}, input length must be a multiple of 5.
2404 Encoding/decoding examples:
2407 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base64
2410 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base64url
2413 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base32
2416 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base32hex
2419 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base16
2422 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base2lsbf
2423 011111111111001001000001
2425 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base2msbf
2426 111111100100111110000010
2428 $ printf '\376\117\202\000' | basenc --z85
2431 $ printf 01010100 | basenc --base2msbf --decode
2434 $ printf 01010100 | basenc --base2lsbf --decode
2440 @node Formatting file contents
2441 @chapter Formatting file contents
2443 @cindex formatting file contents
2445 These commands reformat the contents of files.
2448 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
2449 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
2450 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
2454 @node fmt invocation
2455 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
2458 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
2459 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
2460 @cindex text, reformatting
2462 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
2463 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
2466 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2469 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
2470 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
2472 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
2473 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
2474 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
2477 @cindex line-breaking
2478 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
2479 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
2480 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
2481 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
2482 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
2483 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
2484 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
2485 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
2486 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
2487 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
2488 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
2489 @cite{Software: Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
2492 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2497 @itemx --crown-margin
2499 @opindex --crown-margin
2500 @cindex crown margin
2501 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
2502 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
2503 line with that of the second line.
2506 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
2508 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
2509 @cindex tagged paragraphs
2510 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
2511 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
2512 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
2518 @opindex --split-only
2519 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
2520 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
2521 being unduly combined.
2524 @itemx --uniform-spacing
2526 @opindex --uniform-spacing
2527 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
2528 between sentences to two spaces.
2531 @itemx -w @var{width}
2532 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2533 @opindex -@var{width}
2536 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75 or @var{goal}
2537 plus 10, if @var{goal} is provided).
2540 @itemx --goal=@var{goal}
2543 @command{fmt} initially tries to make lines @var{goal} characters wide.
2544 By default, this is 7% shorter than @var{width}.
2546 @item -p @var{prefix}
2547 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2548 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2549 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2550 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2551 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2552 leaving the code unchanged.
2559 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2562 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2563 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2564 @cindex merging files in parallel
2566 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2567 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2568 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2569 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2572 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2576 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2577 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2578 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2579 The default @var{page_length} is 66
2580 lines. The default number of text lines is therefore 56.
2581 The text line of the header takes the form
2582 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2583 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2584 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2585 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2586 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2587 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2588 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2591 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2592 feeds produce empty pages.
2594 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2595 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2596 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2598 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2599 truncate lines in that case.
2601 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2605 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2606 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2607 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain ':'
2608 @c The 'info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2609 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2610 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2611 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2612 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2613 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2614 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2615 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2616 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2617 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2618 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2619 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2623 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2624 @opindex -@var{column}
2626 @cindex down columns
2627 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2628 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2629 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2630 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2631 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2632 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2633 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2634 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2635 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2636 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2637 with @option{-m} option.
2643 @cindex across columns
2644 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2645 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2646 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2649 @itemx --show-control-chars
2651 @opindex --show-control-chars
2652 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2653 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2654 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2657 @itemx --double-space
2659 @opindex --double-space
2660 @cindex double spacing
2661 Double space the output.
2663 @item -D @var{format}
2664 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2665 @cindex time formats
2666 @cindex formatting times
2667 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2668 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}. @xref{date invocation}.
2669 Except for directives, which start with
2670 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2671 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2672 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2674 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2676 The default date format is @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example,
2677 @samp{2020-07-09 23:59});
2678 but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2679 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the POSIX
2680 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2681 @samp{Jul@ @ 9 23:59 2020}.
2684 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2685 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2686 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2687 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
2689 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2690 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2692 @opindex --expand-tabs
2694 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2695 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2696 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2704 @opindex --form-feed
2705 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. This does
2706 not alter the default page length of 66 lines.
2708 @item -h @var{header}
2709 @itemx --header=@var{header}
2712 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2713 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2714 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2716 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2717 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2719 @opindex --output-tabs
2721 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2722 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2723 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2729 @opindex --join-lines
2730 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2731 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2732 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2733 no column alignment used; may be used with
2734 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2735 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2736 to disentangle the old (POSIX-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2737 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2740 @item -l @var{page_length}
2741 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2744 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2745 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2746 than or equal to 10, the header and footer are omitted, as if the
2747 @option{-t} option had been given.
2753 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2754 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2755 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2757 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2758 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2759 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2760 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2761 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2762 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2763 the middle blank part.
2765 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2766 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2768 @opindex --number-lines
2769 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2770 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2771 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2772 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2773 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2774 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2775 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2776 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2777 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2778 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2779 printed with single column output only. The TAB width varies
2780 with the TAB position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2781 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2782 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a POSIX specification).
2783 The TAB width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2784 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2785 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2786 @var{number-separator} TAB@. The tabification depends upon the output
2789 @item -N @var{line_number}
2790 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2792 @opindex --first-line-number
2793 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2794 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2796 @item -o @var{margin}
2797 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2800 @cindex indenting lines
2802 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2803 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2804 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2805 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2808 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2810 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2811 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2812 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2814 @item -s[@var{char}]
2815 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2817 @opindex --separator
2818 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2819 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2820 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2821 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2822 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2823 @option{-w} is set. This is a POSIX-compliant formulation.
2826 @item -S[@var{string}]
2827 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2829 @opindex --sep-string
2830 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2831 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2832 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2833 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2835 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2836 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}).
2837 If no @samp{@var{string}} argument is specified, @samp{""} is assumed.
2840 @itemx --omit-header
2842 @opindex --omit-header
2843 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2844 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2845 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2846 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2847 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2848 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2849 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2852 @itemx --omit-pagination
2854 @opindex --omit-pagination
2855 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2856 set in the input files.
2859 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2861 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2862 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2864 @item -w @var{page_width}
2865 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2868 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2869 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). The specified
2870 @var{page_width} is rounded down so that columns have equal width.
2871 @option{-s[CHAR]} turns off the default page width and any line truncation
2872 and column alignment.
2873 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2874 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2875 A POSIX-compliant formulation.
2877 @item -W @var{page_width}
2878 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2880 @opindex --page_width
2881 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters, honored with and
2882 without a column option. With a column option, the specified @var{page_width}
2883 is rounded down so that columns have equal width. Text lines are truncated,
2884 unless @option{-J} is used. Together with one of the three column options
2885 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2886 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2887 don't disable the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2888 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2889 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2890 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}@. The header
2891 line is never truncated.
2898 @node fold invocation
2899 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2902 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2903 @cindex folding long input lines
2905 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2906 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2910 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2913 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2914 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2916 @cindex screen columns
2917 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2918 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2919 return sets the column to zero.
2921 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2929 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2930 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2937 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2938 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2939 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2941 @item -w @var{width}
2942 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2945 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2947 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2948 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2956 @node Output of parts of files
2957 @chapter Output of parts of files
2959 @cindex output of parts of files
2960 @cindex parts of files, output of
2962 These commands output pieces of the input.
2965 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2966 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2967 * split invocation:: Split a file into pieces.
2968 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2971 @node head invocation
2972 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2975 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2976 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2978 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2979 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2980 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2983 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2986 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2987 one-line header consisting of:
2990 ==> @var{file name} <==
2994 before the output for each @var{file}.
2996 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3000 @item -c [-]@var{num}
3001 @itemx --bytes=[-]@var{num}
3004 Print the first @var{num} bytes, instead of initial lines.
3005 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{-},
3006 print all but the last @var{num} bytes of each file.
3007 @multiplierSuffixes{num}
3009 @item -n [-]@var{num}
3010 @itemx --lines=[-]@var{num}
3013 Output the first @var{num} lines.
3014 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{-},
3015 print all but the last @var{num} lines of each file.
3016 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
3024 Never print file name headers.
3030 Always print file name headers.
3036 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
3037 @option{-[@var{num}][bkm][cqv]}, which is recognized only if it is
3038 specified first. @var{num} is a decimal number optionally followed
3039 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
3040 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
3041 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{num}}
3042 or @option{-n @var{num}} instead. If your script must also run on
3043 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
3044 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
3050 @node tail invocation
3051 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
3054 @cindex last part of files, outputting
3056 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
3057 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
3058 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3061 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3064 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
3065 one-line header before the output for each @var{file}, consisting of:
3068 ==> @var{file name} <==
3071 For further processing of tail output, it can be useful to convert the
3072 file headers to line prefixes, which can be done like:
3077 /^==> .* <==$/ @{prefix=substr($0,5,length-8)":"; next@}
3082 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
3083 GNU @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
3084 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
3085 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
3086 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
3087 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
3088 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
3089 the GNU @command{tac} command.
3091 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3095 @item -c [+]@var{num}
3096 @itemx --bytes=[+]@var{num}
3099 Output the last @var{num} bytes, instead of final lines.
3100 If @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{+}, start printing with
3101 byte @var{num} from the start of each file. For example to skip the first byte
3102 use @code{tail -c +2}, while to skip all but the last byte use @code{tail -c 1}.
3103 @multiplierSuffixes{num}
3106 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
3109 @cindex growing files
3110 @vindex name @r{follow option}
3111 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
3112 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
3113 presumably because the file is growing.
3114 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
3115 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
3118 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
3119 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
3121 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
3122 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
3123 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
3124 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
3125 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file, perhaps by reopening it
3126 periodically to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
3127 The inotify-based implementation handles this case without
3128 the need for any periodic reopening.
3130 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
3131 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
3132 and resumes tracking from the start of the file, assuming it has been
3133 truncated to 0, which is the usual truncation operation for log files.
3135 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
3136 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
3137 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
3138 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
3139 periodically to see if the file reappears.
3140 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
3141 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
3142 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
3145 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
3146 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
3148 The @option{-f} option is ignored if
3149 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
3150 Likewise, the @option{-f} option has no effect for any
3151 operand specified as @samp{-}, when standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
3153 With kernel inotify support, output is triggered by file changes
3154 and is generally very prompt.
3155 Otherwise, @command{tail} sleeps for one second between checks --
3156 use @option{--sleep-interval=@var{n}} to change that default -- which can
3157 make the output appear slightly less responsive or bursty.
3158 When using tail without inotify support, you can make it more responsive
3159 by using a sub-second sleep interval, e.g., via an alias like this:
3162 alias tail='tail -s.1'
3167 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
3168 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
3169 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
3171 @item --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
3172 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
3173 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
3174 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
3175 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
3176 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
3177 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
3178 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
3179 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
3180 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
3181 This option is meaningful only when polling (i.e., without inotify)
3182 and when following by name.
3184 @item -n [+]@var{num}
3185 @itemx --lines=[+]@var{}
3188 Output the last @var{num} lines.
3189 If @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{+}, start printing with
3190 line @var{num} from the start of each file. For example to skip the first line
3191 use @code{tail -n +2}, while to skip all but the last line use @code{tail -n 1}.
3192 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
3194 @item --pid=@var{pid}
3196 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
3197 @var{pid}, of one or more (by repeating @option{--pid}) writers of the
3198 @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly after all the identified
3199 processes terminate, tail will also terminate. This will
3200 work properly only if the writers and the tailing process are running on
3201 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
3202 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
3203 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
3204 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
3208 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
3211 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
3212 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
3213 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
3214 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
3215 On some systems, @option{--pid} is not supported and @command{tail}
3224 Never print file name headers.
3228 Indefinitely try to open the specified file.
3229 This option is useful mainly when following (and otherwise issues a warning).
3231 When following by file descriptor (i.e., with @option{--follow=descriptor}),
3232 this option only affects the initial open of the file, as after a successful
3233 open, @command{tail} will start following the file descriptor.
3235 When following by name (i.e., with @option{--follow=name}), @command{tail}
3236 infinitely retries to re-open the given files until killed.
3238 Without this option, when @command{tail} encounters a file that doesn't
3239 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
3240 never checks it again.
3242 @item -s @var{number}
3243 @itemx --sleep-interval=@var{number}
3245 @opindex --sleep-interval
3246 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
3247 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
3249 When @command{tail} uses inotify, this polling-related option
3250 is usually ignored. However, if you also specify @option{--pid=@var{p}},
3251 @command{tail} checks whether process @var{p} is alive at least
3252 every @var{number} seconds.
3253 The @var{number} must be non-negative and can be a floating-point number
3254 in either the current or the C locale. @xref{Floating point}.
3260 Always print file name headers.
3266 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
3267 @samp{tail -[@var{num}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
3268 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
3269 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
3270 file. In the option, @var{num} is an optional decimal number optionally
3271 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
3272 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
3273 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
3275 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
3276 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001, the leading @samp{-}
3277 can be replaced by @samp{+} in the traditional option syntax with the
3278 same meaning as in counts, and on obsolete systems predating POSIX
3279 1003.1-2001 traditional usage overrides normal usage when the two
3280 conflict. This behavior can be controlled with the
3281 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
3284 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid traditional
3285 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{num}[b]}, @option{-n
3286 @var{num}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
3287 run on hosts that support only the traditional syntax, you can often
3288 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
3289 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
3290 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
3291 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
3293 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
3294 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the POSIX
3295 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
3296 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
3297 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
3298 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
3299 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
3304 @node split invocation
3305 @section @command{split}: Split a file into pieces.
3308 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
3309 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
3311 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive or interleaved
3312 sections of @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input}
3313 is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3316 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
3319 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
3320 left over for the last section), into each output file.
3322 @cindex output file name prefix
3323 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
3324 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
3325 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
3326 sorted order by file name produces the original input file (except
3327 @option{-nr/@var{n}}). By default split will initially create files
3328 with two generated suffix characters, and will increase this width by two
3329 when the next most significant position reaches the last character.
3330 (@samp{yz}, @samp{zaaa}, @samp{zaab}, @dots{}). In this way an arbitrary
3331 number of output files are supported, which sort as described above,
3332 even in the presence of an @option{--additional-suffix} option.
3333 If the @option{-a} option is specified and the output file names are
3334 exhausted, @command{split} reports an error without deleting the
3335 output files that it did create.
3337 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3341 @item -l @var{lines}
3342 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
3345 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
3346 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3347 the number of records.
3349 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
3350 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use
3351 @option{-l @var{lines}} instead.
3354 @itemx --bytes=@var{size}
3357 Put @var{size} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
3358 @multiplierSuffixes{size}
3361 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{size}
3363 @opindex --line-bytes
3364 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
3365 possible without exceeding @var{size} bytes. Individual lines or records
3366 longer than @var{size} bytes are broken into multiple files.
3367 @var{size} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes} option.
3368 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3369 the number of records.
3371 @item --filter=@var{command}
3373 With this option, rather than simply writing to each output file,
3374 write through a pipe to the specified shell @var{command} for each output file.
3375 @var{command} should use the $FILE environment variable, which is set
3376 to a different output file name for each invocation of the command.
3377 For example, imagine that you have a 1TiB compressed file
3378 that, if uncompressed, would be too large to reside on secondary storage,
3379 yet you must split it into individually-compressed pieces
3380 of a more manageable size.
3381 To do that, you might run this command:
3384 xz -dc BIG.xz | split -b200G --filter='xz > $FILE.xz' - big-
3387 Assuming a 10:1 compression ratio, that would create about fifty 20GiB files
3388 with names @file{big-aa.xz}, @file{big-ab.xz}, @file{big-ac.xz}, etc.
3390 @item -n @var{chunks}
3391 @itemx --number=@var{chunks}
3395 Split @var{input} to @var{chunks} output files where @var{chunks} may be:
3398 @var{n} generate @var{n} files based on current size of @var{input}
3399 @var{k}/@var{n} output only @var{k}th of @var{n} to standard output
3400 l/@var{n} generate @var{n} files without splitting lines or records
3401 l/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but output only @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3402 r/@var{n} like @samp{l} but use round robin distribution
3403 r/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but output only @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3406 If the input size is not a multiple of @var{n}, early output files are
3407 one byte longer than later output files, to make up the difference.
3408 Any excess bytes appearing after the initial calculation are discarded
3409 (except when using @samp{r} mode).
3411 All @var{n} files are created even if there are fewer than @var{n} lines,
3412 or the @var{input} is truncated.
3414 For @samp{l} mode, chunks are approximately @var{input} size / @var{n}.
3415 Although the @var{input} is still partitioned as before into @var{n} regions
3416 of approximately equal size, if a line @emph{starts} within a partition
3417 it is written completely to the corresponding file. Since lines or records
3418 are not split even if they overlap a partition, the files written
3419 can be larger or smaller than the partition size, and even empty
3420 if a line/record is so long as to completely overlap the partition.
3422 When the input is a pipe or some other special file where the size
3423 cannot easily be determined, there is no trouble for @samp{r} mode
3424 because the size of the input is irrelevant. For other modes, such an
3425 input is first copied to a temporary to determine its size.
3427 @item -a @var{length}
3428 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
3430 @opindex --suffix-length
3431 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. If a @var{length} of 0 is specified,
3432 this is the same as if (any previous) @option{-a} was not specified, and
3433 thus enables the default behavior, which starts the suffix length at 2,
3434 and unless @option{-n} or @option{--numeric-suffixes=@var{from}} is
3435 specified, will auto increase the length by 2 as required.
3438 @itemx --numeric-suffixes[=@var{from}]
3440 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
3441 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters. The numerical
3442 suffix counts from @var{from} if specified, 0 otherwise.
3444 @var{from} is supported with the long form option, and is used to either set the
3445 initial suffix for a single run, or to set the suffix offset for independently
3446 split inputs, and consequently the auto suffix length expansion described above
3447 is disabled. Therefore you may also want to use option @option{-a} to allow
3448 suffixes beyond @samp{99}. If option @option{--number} is specified and
3449 the number of files is less than @var{from}, a single run is assumed and the
3450 minimum suffix length required is automatically determined.
3453 @itemx --hex-suffixes[=@var{from}]
3455 @opindex --hex-suffixes
3456 Like @option{--numeric-suffixes}, but use hexadecimal numbers (in lower case).
3458 @item --additional-suffix=@var{suffix}
3459 @opindex --additional-suffix
3460 Append an additional @var{suffix} to output file names. @var{suffix}
3461 must not contain slash.
3464 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3466 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3467 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. This can happen
3468 with the @option{--number} option if a file is (truncated to be) shorter
3469 than the number requested, or if a line is so long as to completely
3470 span a chunk. The output file sequence numbers, always run consecutively
3471 even when this option is specified.
3473 @item -t @var{separator}
3474 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
3476 @opindex --separator
3477 @cindex line separator character
3478 @cindex record separator character
3479 Use character @var{separator} as the record separator instead of the default
3480 newline character (ASCII LF).
3481 To specify ASCII NUL as the separator, use the two-character string @samp{\0},
3482 e.g., @samp{split -t '\0'}.
3487 @opindex --unbuffered
3488 Immediately copy input to output in @option{--number r/@dots{}} mode,
3489 which is a much slower mode of operation.
3493 Write a diagnostic just before each output file is opened.
3499 Here are a few examples to illustrate how the
3500 @option{--number} (@option{-n}) option works:
3502 Notice how, by default, one line may be split onto two or more:
3505 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -n3 k; head xa?
3518 Use the "l/" modifier to suppress that:
3521 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nl/3 k; head xa?
3534 Use the "r/" modifier to distribute lines in a round-robin fashion:
3537 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nr/3 k; head xa?
3550 You can also extract just the Kth chunk.
3551 This extracts and prints just the 7th "chunk" of 33:
3554 $ seq 100 > k; split -nl/7/33 k
3561 @node csplit invocation
3562 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
3565 @cindex context splitting
3566 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
3568 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
3569 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3572 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
3575 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
3576 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
3577 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
3578 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
3579 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
3582 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
3583 output file after it has been created.
3585 The types of pattern arguments are:
3590 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
3591 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
3592 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
3593 file once for each repeat.
3595 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
3596 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
3597 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
3598 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer, that can
3599 be preceded by @samp{+} or @samp{-}.
3600 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
3601 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
3602 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
3603 Lines within a negative offset of a regexp pattern
3604 are not matched in subsequent regexp patterns.
3606 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
3607 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
3608 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
3610 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
3611 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
3612 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
3613 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
3618 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
3619 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
3620 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
3621 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
3622 original input file, excluding portions skipped with a %@var{regexp}%
3623 pattern or the @option{--suppress-matched} option.
3625 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
3626 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
3627 that it has created so far before it exits.
3629 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3633 @item -f @var{prefix}
3634 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
3637 @cindex output file name prefix
3638 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
3640 @item -b @var{format}
3641 @itemx --suffix-format=@var{format}
3643 @opindex --suffix-format
3644 @cindex output file name suffix
3645 Use @var{format} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
3646 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
3647 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
3648 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specification,
3649 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
3650 binary unsigned integer argument to readable form. The format letters
3651 @samp{d} and @samp{i} are aliases for @samp{u}, and the
3652 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
3653 entire @var{format} is given (with the current output file number) to
3654 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
3655 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
3656 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
3658 @item -n @var{digits}
3659 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
3662 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
3663 long instead of the default 2.
3668 @opindex --keep-files
3669 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
3671 @item --suppress-matched
3672 @opindex --suppress-matched
3673 Do not output lines matching the specified @var{pattern}.
3674 I.e., suppress the boundary line from the start of the second
3675 and subsequent splits.
3678 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3680 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3681 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
3682 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
3683 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
3684 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
3685 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
3696 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
3702 Here is an example of its usage.
3703 First, create an empty directory for the exercise,
3710 Now, split the sequence of 1..14 on lines that end with 0 or 5:
3713 $ seq 14 | csplit - '/[05]$/' '@{*@}'
3719 Each number printed above is the size of an output
3720 file that csplit has just created.
3721 List the names of those output files:
3728 Use @command{head} to show their contents:
3753 Example of splitting input by empty lines:
3756 $ csplit --suppress-matched @var{input.txt} '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3760 @c TODO: "uniq" already supports "--group".
3761 @c when it gets the "--key" option, uncomment this example.
3763 @c Example of splitting input file, based on the value of column 2:
3766 @c $ cat @var{input.txt} |
3768 @c uniq --group -k2,2 |
3769 @c csplit -m '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3772 @node Summarizing files
3773 @chapter Summarizing files
3775 @cindex summarizing files
3777 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
3781 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
3782 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
3783 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
3784 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
3785 * b2sum invocation:: Print or check BLAKE2 digests.
3786 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
3787 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
3792 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3796 @cindex character count
3800 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, words, and newlines
3801 in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given
3802 or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. A word is a nonempty sequence of non white
3803 space delimited by white space characters or by start or end of input.
3807 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3810 @cindex total counts
3811 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3812 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. By default
3813 if more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3814 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}.
3815 This @samp{total} line can be controlled with the @option{--total} option,
3816 which is a GNU extension.
3817 The counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3818 maximum line length.
3819 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3820 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3821 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3822 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3823 However, as a GNU extension, if only one count is printed,
3824 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3826 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3827 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3828 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3835 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3837 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3838 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3839 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths. The line lengths here
3840 are measured in screen columns, according to the current locale and
3841 assuming tab positions in every 8th column.
3843 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3851 Print only the byte counts.
3857 Print only the character counts, as per the current locale.
3858 Encoding errors are not counted.
3864 Print only the word counts. A word is a nonempty sequence of non white
3865 space delimited by white space characters or by start or end of input.
3866 The current locale determines which characters are white space.
3867 GNU @command{wc} treats encoding errors as non white space.
3869 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3870 Unless the environment variable @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set,
3871 GNU @command{wc} treats the following Unicode characters as white
3872 space even if the current locale does not: U+00A0 NO-BREAK SPACE,
3873 U+2007 FIGURE SPACE, U+202F NARROW NO-BREAK SPACE, and U+2060 WORD
3880 Print only the newline character counts.
3881 If a file ends in a non-newline character,
3882 its trailing partial line is not counted.
3885 @itemx --max-line-length
3887 @opindex --max-line-length
3888 Print only the maximum display widths.
3889 Tabs are set at every 8th column.
3890 Display widths of wide characters are considered.
3891 Non-printable characters are given 0 width.
3893 @item --total=@var{when}
3894 @opindex --total=@var{when}
3895 Control when and how the final line with cumulative counts is printed.
3896 @var{when} is one of:
3899 @vindex auto @r{total option}
3900 - This is the default mode of @command{wc} when no @option{--total}
3901 option is specified. Output a total line if more than one @var{file}
3904 @vindex always @r{total option}
3905 - Always output a total line, irrespective of the number of files processed.
3907 @vindex only @r{total option}
3908 - Only output total counts. I.e., don't print individual file counts,
3909 suppress any leading spaces, and don't print the @samp{total} word itself,
3910 to simplify subsequent processing.
3912 @vindex none @r{total option}
3913 - Never output a total line.
3916 @macro filesZeroFromOption{cmd,withTotalOption,subListOutput}
3917 @item --files0-from=@var{file}
3918 @opindex --files0-from=@var{file}
3919 @c This is commented out to avoid a texi2dvi failure.
3920 @c texi2dvi (GNU Texinfo 4.11) 1.104
3921 @c @cindex including files from @command{\cmd\}
3922 Disallow processing files named on the command line, and instead process
3923 those named in file @var{file}; each name being terminated by a zero byte
3925 This is useful \withTotalOption\
3926 when the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3928 In such cases, running @command{\cmd\} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3929 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{\cmd\} print
3930 \subListOutput\ for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3931 One way to produce a list of ASCII NUL terminated file
3933 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
3934 If @var{file} is @samp{-} then the ASCII NUL terminated
3935 file names are read from standard input.
3937 @filesZeroFromOption{wc,,a total}
3939 For example, to find the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or
3940 @file{.h} file in the current hierarchy, do this:
3943 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 |
3944 wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3952 @node sum invocation
3953 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3956 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3957 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3959 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3960 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3963 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3966 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3967 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If at least one @var{file}
3968 is given, file names are also printed.
3970 By default, GNU @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3971 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3974 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3980 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3981 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3982 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3983 given, it has no effect.
3989 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3990 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3991 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3995 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3996 next section) is preferable in new applications.
4001 @node cksum invocation
4002 @section @command{cksum}: Print and verify file checksums
4005 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
4006 @cindex CRC checksum
4007 @cindex 32-bit checksum
4008 @cindex checksum, 32-bit
4011 @command{cksum} by default computes a 32-bit cyclic redundancy check (CRC)
4012 checksum for each given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for
4013 a @var{file} of @samp{-}.
4015 cksum also supports the @option{-a/--algorithm} option to select the
4016 digest algorithm to use. @command{cksum} is the preferred interface
4017 to these digests, subsuming the other standalone checksumming utilities,
4018 which can be emulated using @code{cksum -a md5 --untagged "$@@"} etc.
4022 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4025 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files have not been corrupted,
4026 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
4027 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
4031 * cksum output modes:: Legacy and non Legacy output formats
4032 * cksum general options:: Options supported only by cksum
4033 * cksum common options:: Options supported also by standalone utilities
4036 @node cksum output modes
4037 @subsection cksum output modes
4041 @item Legacy output format
4042 @command{cksum} by default prints the POSIX standard CRC checksum
4043 for each file along with the number of bytes in the file,
4044 and the file name unless no arguments were given.
4045 The 32-bit CRC used is based on the polynomial used
4046 for CRC error checking in the ISO/IEC 8802-3:1996 standard (Ethernet).
4047 Similar output formats are used for the other legacy checksums
4048 selectable with @option{--algorithm=sysv} or @option{--algorithm=bsd},
4049 detailed at @ref{sum invocation}.
4051 @item Tagged output format
4052 With the @option{--algorithm} option selecting non legacy checksums,
4053 the @command{cksum} command defaults to output of the form:
4055 @var{digest_name} (@var{file name}) = @var{digest}
4057 The standalone checksum utilities can select this output
4058 mode by using the @option{--tag} option.
4060 @item Untagged output format
4061 With the @option{--untagged} option and the @option{--algorithm} option
4062 selecting non legacy checksums, the following output format is used.
4063 This is the default output format of the standalone checksum utilities.
4064 For each @var{file}, we print the checksum, a space, a flag indicating
4065 binary or text input mode, and the file name.
4066 Binary mode is indicated with @samp{*}, text mode with @samp{ } (space).
4067 Binary mode is the default on systems where it's significant,
4068 otherwise text mode is the default.
4072 Without @option{--zero}, and with non legacy output formats,
4073 if @var{file} contains a backslash, newline, or carriage return,
4074 the line is started with a backslash, and each problematic character
4075 in the file name is escaped with a backslash, making the output unambiguous
4076 even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
4077 Since the backslash character itself is escaped, any other backslash
4078 escape sequences are reserved for future use.
4080 @node cksum general options
4081 @subsection cksum general options
4088 @opindex --algorithm
4089 @cindex digest algorithm
4090 Compute checksums using the specified digest algorithm.
4092 Supported legacy checksums (which are not supported by @option{--check}):
4094 @samp{sysv} equivalent to @command{sum -s}
4095 @samp{bsd} equivalent to @command{sum -r}
4096 @samp{crc} equivalent to @command{cksum} (the default)
4099 Supported more modern digest algorithms are:
4101 @samp{md5} equivalent to @command{md5sum}
4102 @samp{sha1} equivalent to @command{sha1sum}
4103 @samp{sha224} equivalent to @command{sha224sum}
4104 @samp{sha256} equivalent to @command{sha256sum}
4105 @samp{sha384} equivalent to @command{sha384sum}
4106 @samp{sha512} equivalent to @command{sha512sum}
4107 @samp{blake2b} equivalent to @command{b2sum}
4108 @samp{sm3} only available through @command{cksum}
4113 @cindex base64 checksum encoding
4114 Print base64-encoded digests not hexadecimal.
4115 This option is ignored with @option{--check}.
4116 The format conforms to
4117 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc4648#section-4, RFC 4648#4}.
4119 Each base64-encoded digest has zero, one or two trailing padding
4120 (@samp{=}) bytes. The length of that padding is the checksum-bit-length
4121 modulo 3, and the @option{--check} parser requires precisely the same
4122 input digest string as what is output. I.e., removing or adding any
4123 @samp{=} padding renders a digest non-matching.
4127 Output extra information to stderr, like the checksum implementation being used.
4129 @macro cksumLengthOption
4134 @cindex BLAKE2 hash length
4135 Change (shorten) the default digest length.
4136 This is specified in bits and thus must be a multiple of 8.
4137 This option is ignored when @option{--check} is specified,
4138 as the length is automatically determined when checking.
4144 @cindex raw binary checksum
4145 Print only the unencoded raw binary digest for a single input.
4146 Do not output the file name or anything else.
4147 Use network byte order (big endian) where applicable:
4148 for @samp{bsd}, @samp{crc}, and @samp{sysv}.
4149 This option works only with a single input.
4150 Unlike other output formats, @command{cksum} provides no way to
4151 @option{--check} a @option{--raw} checksum.
4155 Output using the original Coreutils format used by the other
4156 standalone checksum utilities like @command{md5sum} for example.
4157 This format has the checksum at the start of the line, and may be
4158 more amenable to further processing by other utilities,
4159 especially in combination with the @option{--zero} option.
4160 This does not identify the digest algorithm used for the checksum.
4161 @xref{cksum output modes} for details of this format.
4164 @node cksum common options
4165 @subsection cksum common options
4173 @cindex binary input files
4174 This option is not supported by the @command{cksum} command,
4175 as it operates in binary mode exclusively.
4176 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
4177 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
4178 On systems like GNU that do not distinguish between binary
4179 and text files, this option merely flags each input mode as binary:
4180 the checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
4181 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
4182 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
4186 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
4187 @var{file} (or from standard input if no @var{file} was specified) and report
4188 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
4189 The input to this mode is usually the output of
4190 a prior, checksum-generating run of the command.
4192 Three input formats are supported. Either the default output
4193 format described above, the @option{--tag} output format,
4194 or the BSD reversed mode format which is similar to the default mode,
4195 but doesn't use a character to distinguish binary and text modes.
4197 For the @command{cksum} command, the @option{--check} option
4198 supports auto-detecting the digest algorithm to use,
4199 when presented with checksum information in the @option{--tag} output format.
4201 Also for the @command{cksum} command, the @option{--check} option
4202 auto-detects the digest encoding, accepting both standard hexadecimal
4203 checksums and those generated via @command{cksum} with its
4204 @option{--base64} option.
4206 Output with @option{--zero} enabled is not supported by @option{--check}.
4208 For each such line, @command{cksum} reads the named file and computes its
4209 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
4210 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
4211 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
4212 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
4213 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
4214 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
4215 a warning is issued to standard error.
4216 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
4217 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
4218 a checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
4219 line is found, @command{cksum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
4220 it exits successfully.
4221 The @command{cksum} command does not support @option{--check}
4222 with the older @samp{sysv}, @samp{bsd}, or @samp{crc} algorithms.
4224 @item --ignore-missing
4225 @opindex --ignore-missing
4226 @cindex verifying checksums
4227 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
4228 When verifying checksums, don't fail or report any status
4229 for missing files. This is useful when verifying a subset
4230 of downloaded files given a larger list of checksums.
4234 @cindex verifying checksums
4235 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
4236 When verifying checksums, don't generate an 'OK' message per successfully
4237 checked file. Files that fail the verification are reported in the
4238 default one-line-per-file format. If there is any checksum mismatch,
4239 print a warning summarizing the failures to standard error.
4243 @cindex verifying checksums
4244 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
4245 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
4246 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
4247 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
4249 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
4250 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
4251 indicating there was a failure.
4256 Output BSD style checksums, which indicate the checksum algorithm used.
4257 As a GNU extension, if @option{--zero} is not used, file names with problematic
4258 characters are escaped as described above, using the same escaping indicator of
4259 @samp{\} at the start of the line, as used with the other output format.
4260 The @option{--tag} option implies binary mode, and is disallowed with
4261 @option{--text} mode as supporting that would unnecessarily complicate
4262 the output format, while providing little benefit.
4263 @xref{cksum output modes} for details of this format.
4264 The @command{cksum} command, uses @option{--tag} as its default output format.
4270 @cindex text input files
4271 This option is not supported by the @command{cksum} command.
4272 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
4273 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
4274 This option is the default on systems like GNU that do not
4275 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
4276 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
4277 terminal. This mode is never defaulted to if @option{--tag} is used.
4283 @cindex verifying checksums
4284 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted checksum lines.
4285 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
4290 @cindex verifying checksums
4291 When verifying checksums,
4292 if one or more input line is invalid,
4293 exit nonzero after all warnings have been issued.
4296 Also file name escaping is not used.
4299 @node md5sum invocation
4300 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
4304 @cindex 128-bit checksum
4305 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
4306 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
4307 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
4309 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
4310 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
4312 @macro weakHash{hash}
4313 The \hash\ digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
4314 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
4315 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical \hash\
4316 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered secure
4317 against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a given \hash\
4318 fingerprint is considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how
4319 to modify certain files, including digital certificates, so that they
4320 appear valid when signed with an \hash\ digest. For more secure hashes,
4321 consider using SHA-2 or @command{b2sum}.
4322 @xref{sha2 utilities}. @xref{b2sum invocation}.
4326 @macro checksumUsage{command}
4327 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
4328 @command{\command\} computes the checksum for the standard input.
4329 @command{\command\} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
4330 consistent. Synopsis:
4333 \command\ [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4336 @command{\command\} uses the @samp{Untagged output format}
4337 for each specified file, as described at @ref{cksum output modes}.
4339 The program accepts @ref{cksum common options}. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4341 @checksumUsage{md5sum}
4346 @node b2sum invocation
4347 @section @command{b2sum}: Print or check BLAKE2 digests
4351 @cindex 512-bit checksum
4352 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
4353 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
4354 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
4356 @command{b2sum} computes a 512-bit checksum for each specified
4359 @checksumUsage{b2sum}
4361 In addition @command{b2sum} supports the following options.
4368 @node sha1sum invocation
4369 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
4373 @cindex 160-bit checksum
4374 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
4375 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
4376 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
4378 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified @var{file}.
4382 @checksumUsage{sha1sum}
4384 @node sha2 utilities
4385 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
4392 @cindex 224-bit checksum
4393 @cindex 256-bit checksum
4394 @cindex 384-bit checksum
4395 @cindex 512-bit checksum
4396 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
4397 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
4398 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
4399 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
4400 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
4401 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
4402 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
4403 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
4404 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
4405 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
4406 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
4407 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
4409 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
4410 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
4411 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
4412 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes.
4414 @checksumUsage{sha???sum}
4417 @node Operating on sorted files
4418 @chapter Operating on sorted files
4420 @cindex operating on sorted files
4421 @cindex sorted files, operations on
4423 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
4426 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
4427 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
4428 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
4429 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
4430 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
4431 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
4435 @node sort invocation
4436 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
4439 @cindex sorting files
4441 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
4442 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
4443 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
4447 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4450 @cindex sort stability
4451 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4452 Many options affect how @command{sort} compares lines; if the results
4453 are unexpected, try the @option{--debug} option to see what happened.
4454 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
4455 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields (see @option{--key}), in the
4456 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
4457 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
4458 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
4459 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
4460 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
4461 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
4462 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
4463 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
4464 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
4465 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
4469 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
4470 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
4471 use a non-POSIX locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
4472 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
4473 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
4474 environment variable to @samp{C}@. Setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
4475 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
4476 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
4477 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
4478 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
4479 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
4480 A line's trailing newline is not part of the line for comparison
4481 purposes. If the final byte of an input file is not a newline, GNU
4482 @command{sort} silently supplies one. GNU @command{sort} (as
4483 specified for all GNU utilities) has no limit on input line length or
4484 restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
4486 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
4487 and check for order. The following options change the operation
4494 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
4497 @cindex checking whether a file is sorted
4498 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
4499 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
4500 exit with a status of 1.
4501 Otherwise, exit successfully.
4502 At most one input file can be given.
4505 @itemx --check=quiet
4506 @itemx --check=silent
4509 @cindex checking whether a file is sorted
4510 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
4511 exit with status 1 otherwise.
4512 At most one input file can be given.
4513 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
4519 @cindex merging sorted files
4520 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
4521 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
4522 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
4527 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
4531 0 if no error occurred
4532 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
4533 2 if an error occurred
4537 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
4538 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
4539 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
4540 the environment variable.
4542 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
4543 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
4544 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
4545 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
4546 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-POSIX
4547 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
4548 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
4553 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
4555 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
4556 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
4558 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
4559 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4560 can change this. Blanks may be ignored by your locale's collating
4561 rules, but without this option they will be significant for character
4562 positions specified in keys with the @option{-k} option.
4565 @itemx --dictionary-order
4567 @opindex --dictionary-order
4568 @cindex dictionary order
4569 @cindex phone directory order
4570 @cindex telephone directory order
4572 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
4573 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
4574 By default letters and digits are those of ASCII and a blank
4575 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
4578 @itemx --ignore-case
4580 @opindex --ignore-case
4581 @cindex ignoring case
4582 @cindex case folding
4584 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
4585 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
4586 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4587 When used with @option{--unique} those lower case equivalent lines are
4588 thrown away. (There is currently no way to throw away the upper case
4589 equivalent instead. (Any @option{--reverse} given would only affect
4590 the final result, after the throwing away.))
4593 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
4594 @itemx --sort=general-numeric
4596 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
4598 @cindex general numeric sort
4600 Sort numerically, converting a prefix of each line to a long
4601 double-precision floating point number. @xref{Floating point}.
4602 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
4603 Use the following collating sequence:
4607 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
4609 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
4610 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
4614 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
4619 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
4620 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
4621 converting to floating point.
4623 You can use this option to sort hexadecimal numbers prefixed with
4624 @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, where those numbers are not fixed width,
4625 or of varying case. However for hex numbers of consistent case,
4626 and left padded with @samp{0} to a consistent width, a standard
4627 lexicographic sort will be faster.
4630 @itemx --human-numeric-sort
4631 @itemx --sort=human-numeric
4633 @opindex --human-numeric-sort
4635 @cindex human numeric sort
4637 Sort numerically, first by numeric sign (negative, zero, or positive);
4638 then by SI suffix (either empty, or @samp{k} or @samp{K}, or
4639 one of @samp{MGTPEZYRQ}, in that order; @pxref{Block size}); and finally
4640 by numeric value. For example, @samp{1023M} sorts before @samp{1G}
4641 because @samp{M} (mega) precedes @samp{G} (giga) as an SI
4642 suffix. This option sorts values that are consistently scaled to the
4643 nearest suffix, regardless of whether suffixes denote powers of 1000
4644 or 1024, and it therefore sorts the output of any single invocation of
4645 the @command{df}, @command{du}, or @command{ls} commands that are
4646 invoked with their @option{--human-readable} or @option{--si} options.
4647 The syntax for numbers is the same as for the @option{--numeric-sort}
4648 option; the SI suffix must immediately follow the number.
4649 To sort more accurately, you can use the @command{numfmt} command
4650 to reformat numbers to human format @emph{after} the sort.
4653 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
4655 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
4656 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
4657 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
4659 Ignore nonprinting characters.
4660 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4661 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
4662 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
4668 @opindex --month-sort
4670 @cindex months, sorting by
4672 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
4673 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
4674 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}@.
4675 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
4676 category determines the month spellings.
4677 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4681 @itemx --numeric-sort
4682 @itemx --sort=numeric
4684 @opindex --numeric-sort
4686 @cindex numeric sort
4689 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
4690 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
4691 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
4692 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
4693 number is treated as @samp{0}. Signs on zeros and leading zeros do
4694 not affect ordering.
4696 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
4698 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale specifies which characters are blanks and
4699 the @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale specifies the thousands separator and
4700 decimal-point character. In the C locale, spaces and tabs are blanks,
4701 there is no thousands separator, and @samp{.} is the decimal point.
4703 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
4704 To compare such strings numerically, use the
4705 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
4708 @itemx --version-sort
4710 @opindex --version-sort
4711 @cindex version number sort
4712 Sort by version name and number. It behaves like a standard sort,
4713 except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
4714 as an index/version number. (@xref{Version sort ordering}.)
4720 @cindex reverse sorting
4721 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
4722 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
4725 @itemx --random-sort
4726 @itemx --sort=random
4728 @opindex --random-sort
4731 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
4732 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
4733 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
4734 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
4735 except that keys with the same value sort together.
4737 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
4738 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
4739 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
4742 The choice of hash function is affected by the
4743 @option{--random-source} option.
4751 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
4752 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
4754 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
4755 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
4756 standard input to standard output.
4758 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
4760 White space and the backslash character should not appear in
4761 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
4763 @filesZeroFromOption{sort,,sorted output}
4765 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4766 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4770 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
4771 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
4772 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
4774 In its simplest form @var{pos} specifies a field number (starting with 1),
4775 with fields being separated by runs of blank characters, and by default
4776 those blanks being included in the comparison at the start of each field.
4777 To adjust the handling of blank characters see the @option{-b} and
4778 @option{-t} options.
4781 each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
4782 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
4783 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
4784 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
4785 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
4786 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
4787 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
4788 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
4789 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
4792 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
4793 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more notes on keys and more examples.
4794 See also the @option{--debug} option to help determine the part
4795 of the line being used in the sort.
4798 Highlight the portion of each line used for sorting.
4799 Also issue warnings about questionable usage to standard error.
4801 @item --batch-size=@var{nmerge}
4802 @opindex --batch-size
4803 @cindex number of inputs to merge, nmerge
4804 Merge at most @var{nmerge} inputs at once.
4806 When @command{sort} has to merge more than @var{nmerge} inputs,
4807 it merges them in groups of @var{nmerge}, saving the result in
4808 a temporary file, which is then used as an input in a subsequent merge.
4810 A large value of @var{nmerge} may improve merge performance and decrease
4811 temporary storage utilization at the expense of increased memory usage
4812 and I/O@. Conversely a small value of @var{nmerge} may reduce memory
4813 requirements and I/O at the expense of temporary storage consumption and
4816 The value of @var{nmerge} must be at least 2. The default value is
4817 currently 16, but this is implementation-dependent and may change in
4820 The value of @var{nmerge} may be bounded by a resource limit for open
4821 file descriptors. The commands @samp{ulimit -n} or @samp{getconf
4822 OPEN_MAX} may display limits for your systems; these limits may be
4823 modified further if your program already has some files open, or if
4824 the operating system has other limits on the number of open files. If
4825 the value of @var{nmerge} exceeds the resource limit, @command{sort}
4826 silently uses a smaller value.
4828 @item -o @var{output-file}
4829 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4832 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4833 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4834 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
4835 @var{output-file}, so you can sort a file in place by using
4836 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}@.
4837 However, it is often safer to output to an otherwise-unused file, as
4838 data may be lost if the system crashes or @command{sort} encounters
4839 an I/O or other serious error while a file is being sorted in place.
4840 Also, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
4841 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
4842 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
4843 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
4845 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4846 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
4847 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}@. Portable
4848 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
4851 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4852 @opindex --random-source
4853 @cindex random source for sorting
4854 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4855 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
4862 @cindex sort stability
4863 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4865 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
4866 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
4867 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
4870 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
4872 @opindex --buffer-size
4873 @cindex size for main memory sorting
4874 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
4875 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
4876 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
4877 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
4878 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
4879 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, @samp{Y}, @samp{R}, and @samp{Q}@.
4881 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
4884 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
4885 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
4886 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
4887 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
4890 @item -t @var{separator}
4891 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
4893 @opindex --field-separator
4894 @cindex field separator character
4895 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
4896 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
4897 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
4898 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4901 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
4902 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
4903 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
4904 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
4905 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
4906 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
4907 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
4908 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
4910 To specify ASCII NUL as the field separator,
4911 use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g., @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
4913 @item -T @var{tempdir}
4914 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
4916 @opindex --temporary-directory
4917 @cindex temporary directory
4919 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
4920 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
4921 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
4922 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
4923 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
4926 @item --parallel=@var{n}
4928 @cindex multithreaded sort
4929 Set the number of sorts run in parallel to @var{n}. By default,
4930 @var{n} is set to the number of available processors, but limited
4931 to 8, as performance gains diminish after that.
4932 Using @var{n} threads increases the memory usage by
4933 a factor of log @var{n}. Also see @ref{nproc invocation}.
4939 @cindex uniquifying output
4941 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
4942 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
4943 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
4945 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
4947 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
4948 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
4949 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
4950 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
4951 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
4954 @macro newlineFieldSeparator
4955 With @option{-z} the newline character is treated as a field separator.
4960 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
4961 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
4962 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}.
4963 GNU sort follows the POSIX
4964 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
4965 According to POSIX, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
4966 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
4967 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
4968 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
4970 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
4971 of the option letters @samp{MbdfghinRrV} appended to it, in which case no
4972 global ordering options are inherited by that particular field. The
4973 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
4974 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
4975 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
4976 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
4977 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b} or
4978 an option that implicitly ignores leading blanks (@samp{Mghn}) as otherwise
4979 the varying numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
4981 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
4982 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
4983 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
4984 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
4986 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4987 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4988 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001,
4989 @command{sort} supports a traditional origin-zero
4990 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
4991 The traditional command @samp{sort +@var{a}.@var{x} -@var{b}.@var{y}}
4992 is equivalent to @samp{sort -k @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b}} if @var{y}
4993 is @samp{0} or absent, otherwise it is equivalent to @samp{sort -k
4994 @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b+1}.@var{y}}.
4996 This traditional behavior can be controlled with the
4997 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4998 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
4999 not set by using the traditional syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
5001 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid traditional
5002 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
5003 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
5004 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
5005 support only the traditional syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
5006 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
5009 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
5014 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
5021 Run no more than 4 sorts concurrently, using a buffer size of 10M.
5024 sort --parallel=4 -S 10M
5028 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
5029 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
5030 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
5031 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
5032 and extending to the end of each line.
5039 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
5040 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
5041 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
5044 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
5047 If you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
5048 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
5049 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
5050 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
5051 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
5053 Also, the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
5054 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
5055 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
5056 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
5057 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
5058 field-end part of the key specifier.
5061 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
5062 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
5063 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
5067 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
5068 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
5069 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
5072 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
5073 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
5074 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
5075 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
5076 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
5077 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
5078 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
5082 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
5083 timestamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
5084 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
5085 files contain lines that look like this:
5088 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2020:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
5089 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2020:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
5092 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
5093 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
5094 because 61 is less than 129.
5097 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
5098 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
5101 This example cannot be done with a single POSIX @command{sort} invocation,
5102 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
5103 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
5104 @command{sort}: the first sorts by timestamp and the second by IPv4
5105 address. The timestamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
5106 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
5107 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
5108 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
5109 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
5110 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
5111 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
5112 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
5113 sorts is stable. As a GNU extension, the above example could
5114 be achieved in a single @command{sort} invocation by sorting the
5115 IPv4 address field using a @samp{V} version type, like @samp{-k1,1V}.
5118 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
5121 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
5124 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
5125 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
5127 by the sort operation.
5129 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
5131 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
5132 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0},
5133 @c then using sort's @option{-z} option,
5134 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
5137 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n' |
5138 @c perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g' |
5140 @c perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
5144 Use the common DSU, Decorate Sort Undecorate idiom to
5145 sort lines according to their length.
5148 awk '@{print length, $0@}' /etc/passwd | sort -n | cut -f2- -d' '
5151 In general this technique can be used to sort data that the @command{sort}
5152 command does not support, or is inefficient at, sorting directly.
5155 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
5156 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
5157 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
5161 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
5167 @node shuf invocation
5168 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
5171 @cindex shuffling files
5173 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
5174 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
5178 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
5179 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
5180 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
5183 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
5184 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
5185 input. The following options change the operation mode:
5193 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
5194 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
5196 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
5197 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
5199 @opindex --input-range
5200 @cindex input range to shuffle
5201 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
5202 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
5206 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
5211 @item -n @var{count}
5212 @itemx --head-count=@var{count}
5214 @opindex --head-count
5215 @cindex head of output
5216 Output at most @var{count} lines. By default, all input lines are
5219 @item -o @var{output-file}
5220 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
5223 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
5224 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
5225 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
5226 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
5227 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
5229 @item --random-source=@var{file}
5230 @opindex --random-source
5231 @cindex random source for shuffling
5232 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
5233 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
5239 @cindex repeat output values
5240 Repeat output values, that is, select with replacement. With this
5241 option the output is not a permutation of the input; instead, each
5242 output line is randomly chosen from all the inputs. This option is
5243 typically combined with @option{--head-count}; if
5244 @option{--head-count} is not given, @command{shuf} repeats
5263 might produce the output
5273 Similarly, the command:
5276 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
5290 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
5300 The above examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
5301 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
5302 general, if there are @var{n} input lines, there are @var{n}! (i.e.,
5303 @var{n} factorial, or @var{n} * (@var{n} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
5304 output permutations.
5307 To output 50 random numbers each in the range 0 through 9, use:
5310 shuf -r -n 50 -i 0-9
5314 To simulate 100 coin flips, use:
5317 shuf -r -n 100 -e Head Tail
5323 @node uniq invocation
5324 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
5327 @cindex uniquify files
5329 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
5330 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
5334 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
5337 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
5338 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
5339 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
5340 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
5342 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
5343 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
5344 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
5345 @xref{sort invocation}.
5348 Comparisons honor the rules specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE}
5351 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
5354 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5359 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
5361 @opindex --skip-fields
5362 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
5363 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields.
5364 Fields are a sequence of blank characters followed by non-blank characters.
5365 Field numbers are one based, i.e., @option{-f 1} will skip the first
5366 field (which may optionally have leading blanks).
5368 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports a traditional option syntax
5369 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
5372 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
5374 @opindex --skip-chars
5375 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
5376 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
5377 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
5379 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
5380 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001,
5381 @command{uniq} supports a traditional option syntax
5383 Although this traditional behavior can be controlled with the
5384 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
5385 conformance}), portable scripts should avoid commands whose
5386 behavior depends on this variable.
5387 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
5388 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
5394 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
5397 @itemx --ignore-case
5399 @opindex --ignore-case
5400 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
5406 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
5407 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
5408 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
5412 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
5414 @opindex --all-repeated
5415 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
5416 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
5417 but discard lines that are not repeated.
5418 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
5419 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
5420 The optional @var{delimit-method}, supported with the long form option,
5421 specifies how to delimit groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the
5427 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
5428 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
5431 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
5432 @macro nulOutputNote
5433 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use a zero
5434 byte (ASCII NUL) instead of a newline as the delimiter.
5439 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
5440 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
5441 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
5442 may be better suited for output direct to users.
5446 @macro ambiguousGroupNote
5447 Output is ambiguous when groups are delimited and the input stream
5448 contains empty lines.
5449 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\\n'} to
5454 This is a GNU extension.
5455 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
5457 @item --group[=@var{delimit-method}]
5459 @cindex all lines, grouping
5460 Output all lines, and delimit each unique group.
5462 The optional @var{delimit-method} specifies how to delimit
5463 groups, and must be one of the following:
5468 Separate unique groups with a single delimiter.
5469 This is the default delimiting method if none is specified,
5470 and better suited for output direct to users.
5473 Output a delimiter before each group of unique items.
5476 Output a delimiter after each group of unique items.
5479 Output a delimiter around each group of unique items.
5484 This is a GNU extension.
5490 @cindex unique lines, outputting
5491 Discard the last line that would be output for a repeated input group.
5492 When used by itself, this option causes @command{uniq} to print unique
5493 lines, and nothing else.
5496 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
5498 @opindex --check-chars
5499 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
5500 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
5504 @newlineFieldSeparator
5511 @node comm invocation
5512 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
5515 @cindex line-by-line comparison
5516 @cindex comparing sorted files
5518 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
5519 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
5520 standard input. Synopsis:
5523 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5527 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
5528 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
5529 If an input file ends in a non-newline
5530 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
5531 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
5533 @cindex differing lines
5534 @cindex common lines
5535 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
5536 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
5537 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
5538 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
5539 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
5540 @c string, append "by default" to the above sentence.
5545 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
5546 the corresponding columns (and separators). Also see @ref{Common options}.
5548 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
5549 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
5550 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
5551 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
5553 @macro checkOrderOption{cmd}
5554 If the @option{--check-order} option is given, unsorted inputs will
5555 cause a fatal error message. If the option @option{--nocheck-order}
5556 is given, unsorted inputs will never cause an error message. If neither
5557 of these options is given, wrongly sorted inputs are diagnosed
5558 only if an input file is found to contain unpairable
5560 lines, and when both input files are non empty.
5562 @ifclear JOIN_COMMAND
5565 If an input file is diagnosed as being unsorted, the @command{\cmd\}
5566 command will exit with a nonzero status (and the output should not be used).
5568 Forcing @command{\cmd\} to process wrongly sorted input files
5569 containing unpairable lines by specifying @option{--nocheck-order} is
5570 not guaranteed to produce any particular output. The output will
5571 probably not correspond with whatever you hoped it would be.
5573 @checkOrderOption{comm}
5578 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
5580 @item --nocheck-order
5581 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order.
5585 @item --output-delimiter=@var{str}
5586 Print @var{str} between adjacent output columns,
5587 rather than the default of a single TAB character.
5589 The delimiter @var{str} may be empty, in which case
5590 the ASCII NUL character is used to delimit output columns.
5593 Output a summary at the end.
5595 Similar to the regular output,
5596 column one contains the total number of lines unique to @var{file1},
5597 column two contains the total number of lines unique to @var{file2}, and
5598 column three contains the total number of lines common to both files,
5599 followed by the word @samp{total} in the additional column four.
5601 In the following example, @command{comm} omits the regular output
5602 (@option{-123}), thus just printing the summary:
5605 $ printf '%s\n' a b c d e > file1
5606 $ printf '%s\n' b c d e f g > file2
5607 $ comm --total -123 file1 file2
5611 This option is a GNU extension. Portable scripts should use @command{wc} to
5612 get the totals, e.g. for the above example files:
5615 $ comm -23 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines only in file1
5617 $ comm -13 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines only in file2
5619 $ comm -12 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines common to both files
5627 @node ptx invocation
5628 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
5632 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
5633 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
5636 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
5637 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
5640 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
5641 all GNU extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
5642 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
5643 When @option{-G} is not specified, GNU extensions are always enabled.
5644 GNU extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
5645 document. @xref{Compatibility in ptx}, for the full list.
5647 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
5649 When GNU extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
5650 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
5651 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
5652 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
5653 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
5654 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
5655 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
5656 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
5659 When GNU extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
5660 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
5661 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
5662 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
5663 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
5664 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
5665 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
5666 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful:}
5667 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
5668 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
5669 compatibility; GNU Standards normally discourage output parameters not
5670 introduced by an option.
5672 For @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
5673 input text file, a single dash @samp{-} may be used, in which case
5674 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
5675 convention more than once per program invocation.
5678 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
5679 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
5680 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
5681 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
5682 * Compatibility in ptx::
5686 @node General options in ptx
5687 @subsection General options
5692 @itemx --traditional
5693 As already explained, this option disables all GNU extensions to
5694 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
5697 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
5701 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
5709 @node Charset selection in ptx
5710 @subsection Charset selection
5712 As it is set up now, @command{ptx} assumes that the input file is coded
5713 using 8-bit characters, and it may not work well in multibyte locales.
5714 In a single-byte locale, the default regular expression
5715 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
5716 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
5719 The output of @command{ptx} assumes the locale's character encoding.
5720 For example, with @command{ptx}'s @option{-T} option, if the locale
5721 uses the Latin-1 encoding you may need a LaTeX directive like
5722 @samp{\usepackage[latin1]@{inputenc@}} to render non-ASCII characters
5728 @itemx --ignore-case
5730 @opindex --ignore-case
5731 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
5736 @node Input processing in ptx
5737 @subsection Word selection and input processing
5742 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
5744 @opindex --break-file
5746 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
5747 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
5748 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
5749 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
5750 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
5751 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
5752 @option{-b} is ignored.
5754 When GNU extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
5755 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
5756 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When GNU extensions
5757 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
5758 characters even if not included in the Break file.
5761 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
5763 @opindex --ignore-file
5765 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5766 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
5767 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
5768 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
5772 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
5774 @opindex --only-file
5776 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5777 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
5778 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
5779 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
5780 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
5782 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
5783 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
5784 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
5789 @opindex --references
5791 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
5792 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
5793 line in the resulting permuted index.
5794 @xref{Output formatting in ptx},
5795 for more information about reference production.
5796 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
5798 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
5799 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
5800 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
5801 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when GNU extensions
5802 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
5803 excluded from the output contexts.
5805 @item -S @var{regexp}
5806 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
5808 @opindex --sentence-regexp
5810 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
5811 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
5812 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
5813 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
5814 default, when GNU extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
5815 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
5816 imported from GNU Emacs:
5819 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
5822 Whenever GNU extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
5823 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
5829 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
5830 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
5831 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
5832 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
5833 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5836 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
5837 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
5838 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
5839 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
5840 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
5841 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
5842 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
5843 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
5844 on the right of the output line.
5846 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5847 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
5848 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5850 @item -W @var{regexp}
5851 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
5853 @opindex --word-regexp
5855 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
5856 By default, if GNU extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
5857 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When GNU extensions are
5858 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
5859 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
5861 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
5862 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5865 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5866 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5867 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5872 @node Output formatting in ptx
5873 @subsection Output formatting
5875 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
5876 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
5877 selected, and if GNU extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
5878 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
5879 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
5880 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
5881 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
5882 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
5883 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
5884 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with GNU
5885 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
5886 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
5887 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
5888 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
5889 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
5890 characters is transmitted verbatim.
5892 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
5896 @item -g @var{number}
5897 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
5901 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
5904 @item -w @var{number}
5905 @itemx --width=@var{number}
5909 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
5910 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
5911 depending on the value of option @option{-R}@. If this option is not
5912 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
5913 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
5914 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
5915 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
5916 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
5920 @itemx --auto-reference
5922 @opindex --auto-reference
5924 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
5925 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
5926 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
5927 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
5928 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
5929 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
5932 @itemx --right-side-refs
5934 @opindex --right-side-refs
5936 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
5937 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
5938 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
5939 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
5940 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
5941 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
5942 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
5943 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
5945 This option is automatically selected whenever GNU extensions are
5948 @item -F @var{string}
5949 @itemx --flag-truncation=@var{string}
5951 @opindex --flag-truncation
5953 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
5954 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
5955 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
5956 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}@. But there is a maximum
5957 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
5958 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
5959 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
5960 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
5961 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
5963 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F @dots{}}.
5964 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
5965 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
5968 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5969 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5970 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5972 @item -M @var{string}
5973 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
5975 @opindex --macro-name
5977 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
5978 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
5981 @itemx --format=roff
5983 @opindex --format=roff
5985 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
5986 processing. Each output line will look like:
5989 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}"@c
5990 "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
5993 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
5994 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when GNU
5995 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
5996 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
5998 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
5999 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
6000 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character @samp{"} is doubled
6001 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
6006 @opindex --format=tex
6008 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
6009 line will look like:
6012 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@c
6013 @{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
6017 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
6018 the output typesetting. When references are not being
6019 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
6020 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
6021 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
6024 In this output format, some special characters, like @samp{$}, @samp{%},
6025 @samp{&}, @samp{#} and @samp{_} are automatically protected with a
6026 backslash. Curly brackets @samp{@{}, @samp{@}} are protected with a
6027 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
6028 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
6029 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
6030 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
6031 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
6032 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
6033 and all other characters which are not part of ASCII, are merely
6034 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
6035 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
6036 processing for @TeX{}.
6041 @node Compatibility in ptx
6042 @subsection The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
6044 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
6045 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
6046 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
6047 options. Some GNU extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
6048 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about GNU extensions.
6049 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
6054 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
6055 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
6056 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
6057 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
6060 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
6061 practice which GNU avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
6062 portably between GNU and System V, you should always use it with a
6063 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
6064 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
6065 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
6066 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
6069 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
6070 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
6071 @option{-w}. All other options are GNU extensions and are not repeated in
6072 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
6073 meaning when GNU extensions are enabled, as explained below.
6076 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
6077 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
6078 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
6081 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
6082 subtracted from the total output line width. With GNU extensions
6083 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
6084 line width computations.
6087 All 256 bytes, even ASCII NUL bytes, are always read and
6088 processed from input file with no adverse effect, even if GNU extensions
6089 are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit
6090 characters, a few control characters are rejected, and the tilde
6091 @samp{~} is also rejected.
6094 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if GNU
6095 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
6096 the first 200 characters in each line.
6099 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
6100 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When GNU
6101 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
6105 The program makes better use of output line width. If GNU extensions
6106 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
6107 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
6108 not completely reproduce.
6111 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
6112 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
6117 @node tsort invocation
6118 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
6121 @cindex topological sort
6123 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
6124 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
6125 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
6129 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
6132 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
6133 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
6134 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
6148 will produce the output
6159 Consider a more realistic example.
6160 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
6161 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
6162 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
6163 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
6164 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
6165 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
6166 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
6167 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
6168 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
6169 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
6170 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
6171 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
6177 tail_file pretty_name
6178 tail_file write_header
6180 tail_forever recheck
6181 tail_forever pretty_name
6182 tail_forever write_header
6183 tail_forever dump_remainder
6186 tail_lines start_lines
6187 tail_lines dump_remainder
6188 tail_lines file_lines
6189 tail_lines pipe_lines
6191 tail_bytes start_bytes
6192 tail_bytes dump_remainder
6193 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
6194 file_lines dump_remainder
6198 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
6199 functions that satisfies your requirement.
6202 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
6222 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
6223 encountered to standard error.
6225 For a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
6226 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
6227 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
6228 precedes @code{main}.
6230 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
6236 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
6239 @node tsort background
6240 @subsection @command{tsort}: Background
6242 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
6243 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
6244 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
6245 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
6248 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
6249 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
6250 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
6251 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
6252 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
6253 reference to @code{read}.
6255 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
6256 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
6257 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
6258 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
6261 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
6262 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
6264 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
6265 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
6266 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
6267 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
6270 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
6271 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
6275 @node Operating on fields
6276 @chapter Operating on fields
6279 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
6280 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
6281 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
6285 @node cut invocation
6286 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
6289 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
6290 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
6294 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6297 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
6298 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
6299 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
6300 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
6301 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
6302 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
6303 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
6304 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
6305 is written exactly once.
6307 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
6312 @item -b @var{byte-list}
6313 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
6316 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
6317 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
6318 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
6319 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
6320 string between ranges of selected bytes.
6322 @item -c @var{character-list}
6323 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
6325 @opindex --characters
6326 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
6327 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
6328 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
6329 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
6330 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
6331 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
6334 @item -f @var{field-list}
6335 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
6338 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
6339 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
6340 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
6341 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified.
6343 The @command{awk} command supports more sophisticated field processing,
6344 like reordering fields, and handling fields aligned with blank characters.
6345 By default @command{awk} uses (and discards) runs of blank characters
6346 to separate fields, and ignores leading and trailing blanks.
6349 awk '{print $2}' # print the second field
6350 awk '{print $(NF-1)}' # print the penultimate field
6351 awk '{print $2,$1}' # reorder the first two fields
6354 While @command{cut} accepts field specifications in
6355 arbitrary order, output is always in the order encountered in the file.
6357 In the unlikely event that @command{awk} is unavailable,
6358 one can use the @command{join} command, to process blank
6359 characters as @command{awk} does above.
6362 join -a1 -o 1.2 - /dev/null # print the second field
6363 join -a1 -o 1.2,1.1 - /dev/null # reorder the first two fields
6367 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
6368 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
6370 @opindex --delimiter
6371 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
6372 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
6376 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
6379 @itemx --only-delimited
6381 @opindex --only-delimited
6382 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
6383 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
6385 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
6386 @opindex --output-delimiter
6387 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
6388 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
6389 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
6390 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
6391 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
6392 ranges of selected bytes.
6395 @opindex --complement
6396 This option is a GNU extension.
6397 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
6398 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
6399 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
6400 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
6401 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
6410 @node paste invocation
6411 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
6414 @cindex merging files
6416 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
6417 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
6418 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
6424 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6438 Take lines sequentially from each file:
6446 Duplicate lines from a file:
6448 $ paste num2 let3 num2
6454 Intermix lines from standard input:
6456 $ paste - let3 - < num2
6462 Join consecutive lines with a space:
6464 $ seq 4 | paste -d ' ' - -
6469 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6477 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
6478 file. Using the above example data:
6481 $ paste -s num2 let3
6486 @item -d @var{delim-list}
6487 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
6489 @opindex --delimiters
6490 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
6491 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
6492 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
6495 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
6508 @node join invocation
6509 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
6512 @cindex common field, joining on
6514 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
6515 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
6518 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
6521 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
6522 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
6523 sorted on the join fields.
6545 @command{join}'s default behavior (when no options are given):
6547 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
6548 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
6549 blanks on the line ignored;
6550 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
6551 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
6552 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
6557 * General options in join:: Options which affect general program behavior.
6558 * Sorting files for join:: Using @command{sort} before @command{join}.
6559 * Working with fields:: Joining on different fields.
6560 * Paired and unpaired lines:: Controlling @command{join}'s field matching.
6561 * Header lines:: Working with header lines in files.
6562 * Set operations:: Union, Intersection and Difference of files.
6565 @node General options in join
6566 @subsection General options
6567 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6571 @item -a @var{file-number}
6573 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
6574 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
6577 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
6579 @item --nocheck-order
6580 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order. This is the default.
6582 @item -e @var{string}
6584 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with @var{string}.
6585 I.e., missing fields specified with the @option{-12jo} options.
6589 Treat the first line of each input file as a header line. The header lines
6590 will be joined and printed as the first output line. If @option{-o} is used to
6591 specify output format, the header line will be printed according to the
6592 specified format. The header lines will not be checked for ordering even if
6593 @option{--check-order} is specified. Also if the header lines from each file
6594 do not match, the heading fields from the first file will be used.
6597 @itemx --ignore-case
6599 @opindex --ignore-case
6600 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
6601 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
6602 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
6604 @item -1 @var{field}
6606 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
6608 @item -2 @var{field}
6610 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
6612 @item -j @var{field}
6613 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
6615 @item -o @var{field-list}
6617 If the keyword @samp{auto} is specified, infer the output format from
6618 the first line in each file. This is the same as the default output format
6619 but also ensures the same number of fields are output for each line.
6620 Missing fields are replaced with the @option{-e} option and extra fields
6623 Otherwise, construct each output line according to the format in
6624 @var{field-list}. Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single
6625 character @samp{0} or has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m},
6626 is @samp{1} or @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
6628 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
6629 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
6630 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
6631 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
6632 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
6633 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
6634 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
6635 To give @command{join} that functionality, POSIX invented the @samp{0}
6636 field specification notation.
6638 The elements in @var{field-list}
6639 are separated by commas or blanks.
6640 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
6641 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
6642 2.2'} are equivalent.
6644 All output lines -- including those printed because of any @option{-a}
6645 or @option{-v} option -- are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
6648 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
6649 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
6650 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
6651 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering. If @samp{join -t ''} is specified,
6652 the whole line is considered, matching the default operation of sort.
6653 If @samp{-t '\0'} is specified then the ASCII NUL
6654 character is used to delimit the fields.
6656 @item -v @var{file-number}
6657 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
6658 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
6661 @newlineFieldSeparator
6668 @checkOrderOption{join}
6673 @node Sorting files for join
6674 @subsection Pre-sorting
6676 @command{join} requires sorted input files. Each input file should be
6677 sorted according to the key (=field/column number) used in
6678 @command{join}. The recommended sorting option is @samp{sort -k 1b,1}
6679 (assuming the desired key is in the first column).
6681 @noindent Typical usage:
6684 $ sort -k 1b,1 file1 > file1.sorted
6685 $ sort -k 1b,1 file2 > file2.sorted
6686 $ join file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6691 Normally, the sort order is that of the
6692 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
6693 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
6694 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
6695 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
6696 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}:
6700 $ sort -k 1bf,1 file1 > file1.sorted
6701 $ sort -k 1bf,1 file2 > file2.sorted
6702 $ join --ignore-case file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6706 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
6707 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
6708 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
6709 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
6710 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
6711 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
6713 @noindent To avoid any locale-related issues, it is recommended to use the
6714 @samp{C} locale for both commands:
6718 $ LC_ALL=C sort -k 1b,1 file1 > file1.sorted
6719 $ LC_ALL=C sort -k 1b,1 file2 > file2.sorted
6720 $ LC_ALL=C join file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6725 @node Working with fields
6726 @subsection Working with fields
6728 Use @option{-1},@option{-2} to set the key fields for each of the input files.
6729 Ensure the preceding @command{sort} commands operated on the same fields.
6732 The following example joins two files, using the values from seventh field
6733 of the first file and the third field of the second file:
6737 $ sort -k 7b,7 file1 > file1.sorted
6738 $ sort -k 3b,3 file2 > file2.sorted
6739 $ join -1 7 -2 3 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6744 If the field number is the same for both files, use @option{-j}:
6748 $ sort -k4b,4 file1 > file1.sorted
6749 $ sort -k4b,4 file2 > file2.sorted
6750 $ join -j4 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6755 Both @command{sort} and @command{join} operate of whitespace-delimited
6756 fields. To specify a different delimiter, use @option{-t} in @emph{both}:
6760 $ sort -t, -k3b,3 file1 > file1.sorted
6761 $ sort -t, -k3b,3 file2 > file2.sorted
6762 $ join -t, -j3 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6767 To specify a tab (@sc{ascii} 0x09) character instead of whitespace,
6768 use:@footnote{the @code{$'\t'} is supported in most modern shells.
6769 For older shells, use a literal tab.}
6773 $ sort -t$'\t' -k3b,3 file1 > file1.sorted
6774 $ sort -t$'\t' -k3b,3 file2 > file2.sorted
6775 $ join -t$'\t' -j3 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6781 If @samp{join -t ''} is specified then the whole line is considered which
6782 matches the default operation of sort:
6786 $ sort file1 > file1.sorted
6787 $ sort file2 > file2.sorted
6788 $ join -t '' file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6793 @node Paired and unpaired lines
6794 @subsection Controlling @command{join}'s field matching
6796 In this section the @command{sort} commands are omitted for brevity.
6797 Sorting the files before joining is still required.
6799 @command{join}'s default behavior is to print only lines common to
6800 both input files. Use @option{-a} and @option{-v} to print unpairable lines
6801 from one or both files.
6804 All examples below use the following two (pre-sorted) input files:
6806 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
6823 @c TODO: Find better column widths that work for both HTML and PDF
6824 @c and disable indentation of @example.
6825 @multitable @columnfractions 0.5 0.5
6827 @headitem Command @tab Outcome
6837 (@emph{intersection})
6843 $ join -a 1 file1 file2
6848 common lines @emph{and} unpaired
6849 lines from the first file
6854 $ join -a 2 file1 file2
6859 common lines @emph{and} unpaired lines from the second file
6864 $ join -a 1 -a 2 file1 file2
6870 all lines (paired and unpaired) from both files
6873 see note below regarding @code{-o auto}.
6878 $ join -v 1 file1 file2
6882 unpaired lines from the first file
6888 $ join -v 2 file1 file2
6892 unpaired lines from the second file
6898 $ join -v 1 -v 2 file1 file2
6903 unpaired lines from both files, omitting common lines
6904 (@emph{symmetric difference}).
6910 The @option{-o auto -e X} options are useful when dealing with unpaired lines.
6911 The following example prints all lines (common and unpaired) from both files.
6912 Without @option{-o auto} it is not easy to discern which fields originate from
6916 $ join -a 1 -a 2 file1 file2
6921 $ join -o auto -e X -a 1 -a 2 file1 file2
6928 If the input has no unpairable lines, a GNU extension is
6929 available; the sort order can be any order that considers two fields
6930 to be equal if and only if the sort comparison described above
6931 considers them to be equal. For example:
6954 @subsection Header lines
6956 The @option{--header} option can be used when the files to join
6957 have a header line which is not sorted:
6971 $ join --header -o auto -e NA -a1 -a2 file1 file2
6980 To sort a file with a header line, use GNU @command{sed -u}.
6981 The following example sort the files but keeps the first line of each
6986 $ ( sed -u 1q ; sort -k2b,2 ) < file1 > file1.sorted
6987 $ ( sed -u 1q ; sort -k2b,2 ) < file2 > file2.sorted
6988 $ join --header -o auto -e NA -a1 -a2 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6992 @node Set operations
6993 @subsection Union, Intersection and Difference of files
6995 Combine @command{sort}, @command{uniq} and @command{join} to
6996 perform the equivalent of set operations on files:
6998 @c From https://www.pixelbeat.org/cmdline.html#sets
6999 @multitable @columnfractions 0.5 0.5
7000 @headitem Command @tab outcome
7001 @item @code{sort -u file1 file2}
7002 @tab Union of unsorted files
7004 @item @code{sort file1 file2 | uniq -d}
7005 @tab Intersection of unsorted files
7007 @item @code{sort file1 file1 file2 | uniq -u}
7008 @tab Difference of unsorted files
7010 @item @code{sort file1 file2 | uniq -u}
7011 @tab Symmetric Difference of unsorted files
7013 @item @code{join -t '' -a1 -a2 file1 file2}
7014 @tab Union of sorted files
7016 @item @code{join -t '' file1 file2}
7017 @tab Intersection of sorted files
7019 @item @code{join -t '' -v2 file1 file2}
7020 @tab Difference of sorted files
7022 @item @code{join -t '' -v1 -v2 file1 file2}
7023 @tab Symmetric Difference of sorted files
7027 All examples above operate on entire lines and not on specific fields:
7028 @command{sort} without @option{-k} and @command{join -t ''} both consider
7029 entire lines as the key.
7032 @node Operating on characters
7033 @chapter Operating on characters
7035 @cindex operating on characters
7037 These commands operate on individual characters.
7040 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
7041 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
7042 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
7047 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
7054 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{string1} [@var{string2}]
7057 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
7058 one of the following operations:
7062 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
7064 squeeze repeated characters,
7068 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
7071 The @var{string1} and @var{string2} operands define arrays of
7072 characters @var{array1} and @var{array2}. By default @var{array1}
7073 lists input characters that @command{tr} operates on, and @var{array2}
7074 lists corresponding translations. In some cases the second operand is
7077 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7078 Options must precede operands.
7087 @opindex --complement
7088 Instead of @var{array1}, use its complement (all characters not
7089 specified by @var{string1}), in ascending order. Use this option with
7090 caution in multibyte locales where its meaning is not always clear
7091 or portable; see @ref{Character arrays}.
7097 Delete characters in @var{array1}; do not translate.
7100 @itemx --squeeze-repeats
7102 @opindex --squeeze-repeats
7103 Replace each sequence of a repeated character that is listed in
7104 the last specified @var{array}, with a single occurrence of that character.
7107 @itemx --truncate-set1
7109 @opindex --truncate-set1
7110 Truncate @var{array1} to the length of @var{array2}.
7118 * Character arrays:: Specifying arrays of characters.
7119 * Translating:: Changing characters to other characters.
7120 * Squeezing and deleting:: Removing characters.
7124 @node Character arrays
7125 @subsection Specifying arrays of characters
7127 @cindex arrays of characters in @command{tr}
7129 The @var{string1} and @var{string2} operands are not regular
7130 expressions, even though they may look similar. Instead, they
7131 merely represent arrays of characters. As a GNU extension to POSIX,
7132 an empty string operand represents an empty array of characters.
7134 The interpretation of @var{string1} and @var{string2} depends on locale.
7135 GNU @command{tr} fully supports only safe single-byte locales,
7136 where each possible input byte represents a single character.
7137 Unfortunately, this means GNU @command{tr} will not handle commands
7138 like @samp{tr @"o @L{}} the way you might expect,
7139 since (assuming a UTF-8 encoding) this is equivalent to
7140 @samp{tr '\303\266' '\305\201'} and GNU @command{tr} will
7141 simply transliterate all @samp{\303} bytes to @samp{\305} bytes, etc.
7142 POSIX does not clearly specify the behavior of @command{tr} in locales
7143 where characters are represented by byte sequences instead of by
7144 individual bytes, or where data might contain invalid bytes that are
7145 encoding errors. To avoid problems in this area, you can run
7146 @command{tr} in a safe single-byte locale by using a shell command
7147 like @samp{LC_ALL=C tr} instead of plain @command{tr}.
7149 Although most characters simply represent themselves in @var{string1}
7150 and @var{string2}, the strings can contain shorthands listed below,
7151 for convenience. Some shorthands can be used only in @var{string1} or
7152 @var{string2}, as noted below.
7156 @item Backslash escapes
7157 @cindex backslash escapes
7159 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
7163 Bell (BEL, Control-G).
7165 Backspace (BS, Control-H).
7167 Form feed (FF, Control-L).
7169 Newline (LF, Control-J).
7171 Carriage return (CR, Control-M).
7173 Tab (HT, Control-I).
7175 Vertical tab (VT, Control-K).
7177 The eight-bit byte with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is the longest
7178 sequence of one to three octal digits following the backslash.
7179 For portability, @var{ooo} should represent a value that fits in eight bits.
7180 As a GNU extension to POSIX, if the value would not fit, then only the
7181 first two digits of @var{ooo} are used, e.g., @samp{\400}
7182 is equivalent to @samp{\0400} and represents a two-byte sequence.
7187 It is an error if no character follows an unescaped backslash.
7188 As a GNU extension, a backslash followed by a character not listed
7189 above is interpreted as that character, removing any special
7190 significance; this can be used to escape the characters
7191 @samp{[} and @samp{-} when they would otherwise be special.
7196 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to the characters
7197 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
7198 not collate after @var{n}; if it does, an error results. As an example,
7199 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
7201 GNU @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
7202 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
7203 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
7204 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
7205 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
7208 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not fully
7209 portable. For example, on EBCDIC hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
7210 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
7211 are not contiguous as they are in ASCII@.
7212 One way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
7213 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
7216 @item Repeated characters
7217 @cindex repeated characters
7219 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{string2} expands to @var{n}
7220 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
7221 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
7222 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{array2} as long as
7223 @var{array1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
7224 octal, otherwise in decimal. A zero-valued @var{n} is treated as if
7227 @item Character classes
7228 @cindex character classes
7230 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all characters in
7231 the (predefined) class @var{class}. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
7232 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
7233 character class can be used in @var{string2}. Otherwise, only the
7234 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
7235 @var{string2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
7236 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
7237 relative position in @var{string1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
7238 Except for case conversion, a class's characters appear in no particular order.
7239 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
7251 Horizontal whitespace.
7260 Printable characters, not including space.
7266 Printable characters, including space.
7269 Punctuation characters.
7272 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
7281 @item Equivalence classes
7282 @cindex equivalence classes
7284 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all characters equivalent to
7285 @var{c}, in no particular order. These equivalence classes are
7286 allowed in @var{string2} only when @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) and
7287 @option{--squeeze-repeats} @option{-s} are both given.
7289 Although equivalence classes are intended to support non-English alphabets,
7290 there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
7291 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in GNU @command{tr};
7292 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
7293 which is of no particular use.
7299 @subsection Translating
7301 @cindex translating characters
7303 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{string1} and @var{string2} are
7304 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
7305 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{array1}
7306 to the corresponding character in @var{array2}. Characters not in
7307 @var{array1} are passed through unchanged.
7309 As a GNU extension to POSIX, when a character appears more than once
7310 in @var{array1}, only the final instance is used. For example, these
7311 two commands are equivalent:
7318 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
7319 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
7322 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
7324 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
7328 However, ranges like @code{a-z} are not portable outside the C locale.
7330 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{array1} and @var{array2}
7331 typically have the same length. If @var{array1} is shorter than
7332 @var{array2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{array2} are ignored.
7334 On the other hand, making @var{array1} longer than @var{array2} is not
7335 portable; POSIX says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
7336 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{array2} to the length of @var{array1} by repeating
7337 the last character of @var{array2} as many times as necessary. System V
7338 @command{tr} truncates @var{array1} to the length of @var{array2}.
7340 By default, GNU @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
7341 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
7342 GNU @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
7343 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
7345 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
7349 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
7353 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
7354 complement of @var{array1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
7358 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
7359 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012. Here is a better
7363 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
7367 @node Squeezing and deleting
7368 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
7370 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
7371 @cindex deleting characters
7372 @cindex removing characters
7374 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
7375 removes any input characters that are in @var{array1}.
7377 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option
7378 and not translating, @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a
7379 repeated character that is in @var{array1} with a single occurrence of
7382 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
7383 first performs any deletions using @var{array1}, then squeezes repeats
7384 from any remaining characters using @var{array2}.
7386 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
7387 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
7388 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{array2}.
7390 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
7395 Remove all zero bytes:
7402 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
7403 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
7404 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
7407 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
7411 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline.
7412 I.e., delete empty lines:
7419 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
7420 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
7421 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
7422 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
7423 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
7424 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
7425 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
7426 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
7432 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
7433 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
7438 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
7439 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
7445 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
7446 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
7447 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
7448 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
7449 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
7450 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
7451 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
7452 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
7453 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
7460 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
7469 @node expand invocation
7470 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
7473 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
7474 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
7476 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
7477 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
7478 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
7482 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
7485 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
7486 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
7487 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
7488 tabs every 8 columns).
7490 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7494 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7495 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7498 @cindex tab stops, setting
7499 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
7500 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
7501 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
7502 last tab stop given with single spaces.
7503 @macro gnuExpandTabs
7504 Tab stops can be separated by blanks as well as by commas.
7506 As a GNU extension the last @var{tab} specified can be prefixed
7507 with a @samp{/} to indicate a tab size to use for remaining positions.
7508 For example, @option{--tabs=2,4,/8} will set tab stops at position 2 and 4,
7509 and every multiple of 8 after that.
7511 Also the last @var{tab} specified can be prefixed with a @samp{+} to indicate
7512 a tab size to use for remaining positions, offset from the final explicitly
7514 For example, to ignore the 1 character gutter present in diff output,
7515 one can specify a 1 character offset using @option{--tabs=1,+8},
7516 which will set tab stops at positions 1,9,17,@dots{}
7521 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
7522 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
7523 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
7529 @cindex initial tabs, converting
7530 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
7531 characters) on each line to spaces.
7538 @node unexpand invocation
7539 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
7543 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
7544 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
7545 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
7546 as many tab characters as needed. In the default POSIX
7547 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
7548 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
7551 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
7554 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
7555 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
7556 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
7557 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
7560 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7564 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7565 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7568 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
7569 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
7570 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
7571 beyond the tab stops given unchanged.
7574 This option implies the @option{-a} option.
7576 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
7577 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
7578 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
7579 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
7580 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
7586 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
7587 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
7594 @node Directory listing
7595 @chapter Directory listing
7597 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
7598 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
7601 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
7602 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
7603 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
7604 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
7609 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
7612 @cindex directory listing
7614 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
7615 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
7616 arbitrarily, as usual. Later options override earlier options that
7619 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
7620 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
7621 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
7622 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
7623 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
7624 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
7627 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
7628 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-POSIX
7629 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
7630 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
7631 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
7632 If standard output is
7633 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
7634 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
7635 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
7637 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
7638 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
7639 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
7640 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
7641 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
7643 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
7648 1 minor problems (e.g., failure to access a file or directory not
7649 specified as a command line argument. This happens when listing a
7650 directory in which entries are actively being removed or renamed.)
7651 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted, invalid option, failure
7652 to access a file or directory specified as a command line argument
7653 or a directory loop)
7656 Also see @ref{Common options}.
7659 * Which files are listed::
7660 * What information is listed::
7661 * Sorting the output::
7662 * General output formatting::
7663 * Formatting file timestamps::
7664 * Formatting the file names::
7668 @node Which files are listed
7669 @subsection Which files are listed
7671 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
7672 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
7673 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
7674 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
7682 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
7687 @opindex --almost-all
7688 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
7689 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
7690 option overrides this option.
7693 @itemx --ignore-backups
7695 @opindex --ignore-backups
7696 @cindex backup files, ignoring
7697 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
7698 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
7703 @opindex --directory
7704 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
7705 than listing their contents.
7706 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
7707 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
7708 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
7709 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
7710 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
7713 @itemx --dereference-command-line
7715 @opindex --dereference-command-line
7716 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
7717 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
7718 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
7720 @item --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
7721 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
7722 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
7723 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
7724 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
7725 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
7727 This is the default behavior unless long format is being used
7728 or any of the following options is in effect:
7729 @option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
7730 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
7731 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
7732 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
7734 @item --group-directories-first
7735 @opindex --group-directories-first
7736 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
7737 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
7738 (see @option{--sort} option).
7739 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
7740 and the @option{--sort} option specifies a secondary key.
7741 However, any use of @option{--sort=none}
7742 (@option{-U}) disables this option altogether.
7744 @item --hide=PATTERN
7745 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
7746 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
7747 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
7748 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
7749 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
7750 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
7751 (@option{-A}) is also given.
7753 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
7754 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
7755 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
7756 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
7758 @item -I @var{pattern}
7759 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
7761 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
7762 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
7763 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
7764 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
7765 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
7766 to give this option several times. For example,
7769 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
7772 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
7773 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
7774 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
7777 @itemx --dereference
7779 @opindex --dereference
7780 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
7781 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
7782 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
7783 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
7784 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
7789 @opindex --recursive
7790 @cindex recursive directory listing
7791 @cindex directory listing, recursive
7792 List the contents of all directories recursively.
7797 @node What information is listed
7798 @subsection What information is listed
7800 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
7801 default, only file names are shown.
7807 @cindex hurd, author, printing
7808 In long format, list each file's author.
7809 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
7810 operating systems the two are the same.
7816 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
7817 Print an additional line after the main output:
7820 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
7824 The @var{begn} and @var{endn} are unsigned integers that record the
7825 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
7826 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
7827 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
7829 If directories are being listed recursively via
7830 @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}), output a similar
7831 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
7834 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
7837 Finally, output a line of the form:
7840 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
7844 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
7846 Here is an actual example:
7849 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
7851 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
7852 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
7855 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
7856 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
7857 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
7858 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
7862 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
7866 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
7870 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
7871 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
7872 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
7875 The pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
7876 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
7878 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
7879 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
7881 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
7882 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
7885 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
7886 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
7890 Although the listing above includes a trailing slash
7891 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
7892 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
7893 (@option{-D}) along with an option like
7894 @option{--escape} (@option{-b}) and operate
7895 on a file whose name contains special characters, the backslash
7900 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
7901 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
7903 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
7906 If you use a quoting style like @option{--quoting-style=c} (@option{-Q})
7907 that adds quote marks, then the offsets include the quote marks.
7908 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
7909 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
7910 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal}
7911 (@option{-N}) option on the command line, or else be
7912 prepared to parse the escaped names.
7914 The @option{--dired} (@option{-D}) option implies long format output
7915 with hyperlinks disabled, and takes precedence over previously specified
7916 output formats or hyperlink mode.
7919 @opindex --full-time
7920 Produce long format, and list times in full. It is
7921 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} (@option{-l}) with
7922 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
7926 Produce long format, but omit owner information.
7932 Inhibit display of group information in long format.
7933 (This is the default in some non-GNU versions of @command{ls}, so we
7934 provide this option for compatibility.)
7942 @cindex inode number, printing
7943 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
7944 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
7945 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
7948 @itemx --format=long
7949 @itemx --format=verbose
7952 @opindex long ls @r{format}
7953 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
7954 Produce long format.
7955 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
7956 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
7957 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
7958 the modification timestamp (the mtime, @pxref{File timestamps}).
7959 If the owner or group name cannot be determined, print
7960 the owner or group ID instead, right-justified as a cue
7961 that it is a number rather than a textual name.
7962 Print question marks for other information that
7963 cannot be determined.
7965 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
7966 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
7967 For example, @option{--human-readable} (@option{-h})
7968 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
7969 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
7970 separator of the current locale.
7972 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
7973 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the file system allocation
7974 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
7975 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
7976 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
7977 this is arguably a deficiency.
7979 The file type is one of the following characters:
7981 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
7989 character special file
7991 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
7997 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
8001 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
8003 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
8005 network special file (HP-UX)
8011 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
8015 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
8017 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
8019 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
8021 some other file type
8024 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
8025 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
8026 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
8027 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
8031 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
8035 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
8036 executable bit is not set.
8039 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
8040 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
8041 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
8044 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
8045 other-executable bit is not set.
8048 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
8054 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
8055 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
8056 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
8057 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
8058 character, then there is such a method.
8060 GNU @command{ls} uses a @samp{.} character to indicate a file
8061 with a security context, but no other alternate access method.
8063 A file with any other combination of alternate access methods
8064 is marked with a @samp{+} character.
8067 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
8069 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
8070 @cindex numeric uid and gid
8071 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
8072 Produce long format, but
8073 display right-justified numeric user and group IDs
8074 instead of left-justified owner and group names.
8078 Produce long format, but omit group information.
8079 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} (@option{-l})
8080 with @option{--no-group} (@option{-G}).
8086 @cindex file system allocation
8087 @cindex size of files, reporting
8088 Print the file system allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
8089 This is the amount of file system space used by the file, which is usually a
8090 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
8092 Normally the allocation is printed in units of
8093 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
8095 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
8096 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
8097 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
8098 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
8099 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
8100 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
8109 @cindex security context
8110 Display the SELinux security context or @samp{?} if none is found.
8111 In long format, print the security context to the left of the size column.
8116 @node Sorting the output
8117 @subsection Sorting the output
8119 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
8120 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
8121 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
8122 (e.g., ASCII order).
8128 @itemx --time=status
8131 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
8132 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
8133 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8135 print the status change timestamp (the ctime) instead of the mtime.
8136 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8137 sort according to the ctime. @xref{File timestamps}.
8141 @cindex unsorted directory listing
8142 @cindex directory order, listing by
8143 Produce an unsorted directory listing.
8144 This is like @option{--sort=none} (@option{-U}),
8145 but also enable @option{--all} (@option{-a}),
8146 while also disabling any previous use of @option{-l}, @option{--color}
8147 @option{--size}, or @option{--hyperlink}.
8153 @cindex reverse sorting
8154 Reverse whatever the sorting method is -- e.g., list files in reverse
8155 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
8156 This option has no effect when @option{--sort=none} (@option{-U})
8163 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
8164 Sort by file size, largest first.
8170 @opindex modification timestamp@r{, sorting files by}
8171 Sort by modification timestamp (mtime) by default, newest first.
8172 The timestamp to order by can be changed with the @option{--time} option.
8173 @xref{File timestamps}.
8177 @itemx --time=access
8181 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8182 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8183 @opindex access timestamp@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8184 In long format, print the last access timestamp (the atime).
8185 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8186 sort according to the atime.
8187 @xref{File timestamps}.
8190 @itemx --time=modification
8192 @opindex data modification time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8193 @opindex mtime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8194 This is the default timestamp display and sorting mode.
8195 In long format, print the last data modification timestamp (the mtime).
8196 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8197 sort according to the mtime.
8198 @xref{File timestamps}.
8201 @itemx --time=creation
8203 @opindex birth time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8204 @opindex creation timestamp@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8205 In long format, print the file creation timestamp if available,
8206 falling back to the file modification timestamp (mtime) if not.
8207 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8208 sort according to the birth time.
8209 @xref{File timestamps}.
8215 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
8216 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
8217 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
8218 that @option{-f} does.) This can be useful when listing large
8219 directories, where sorting can take some time.
8222 @itemx --sort=version
8225 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
8226 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
8227 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
8228 as an index/version number. @xref{Version sort ordering}.
8232 @opindex width@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
8233 Sort by printed width of file names.
8234 This can be useful with the @option{--format=vertical} (@option{-C})
8235 output format, to most densely display the listed files.
8238 @itemx --sort=extension
8241 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
8242 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
8243 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
8248 @node General output formatting
8249 @subsection General output formatting
8251 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
8255 @item --format=single-column
8257 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
8258 List one file name per line, with no other information.
8259 This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
8260 output is not a terminal. See also the @option{--escape} (@option{-b}),
8261 @option{--hide-control-chars} (@option{-q}), and @option{--zero} options
8262 to disambiguate output of file names containing newline characters.
8266 List one file per line. This is like @option{--format=single-column}
8267 except that it has no effect if long format is also in effect.
8270 @itemx --format=vertical
8273 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
8274 List files in columns, sorted vertically, with no other information.
8275 This is the default for @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal.
8276 It is always the default for the @command{dir} program.
8277 GNU @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
8278 possible in the fewest lines.
8280 @item --color [=@var{when}]
8282 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
8283 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types; @var{when}
8284 may be omitted, or one of:
8287 @vindex none @r{color option}
8288 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
8290 @vindex auto @r{color option}
8291 @cindex terminal, using color iff
8292 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
8294 @vindex always @r{color option}
8297 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
8298 @option{--color=always}.
8299 If piping a colored listing through a pager like @command{less},
8300 use the pager's @option{-R} option to pass the color codes to the terminal.
8303 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
8304 Using the @option{--color} option may incur a noticeable
8305 performance penalty when run in a large directory,
8306 because the default settings require that @command{ls} @code{stat} every
8307 single file it lists.
8308 However, if you would like most of the file-type coloring
8309 but can live without the other coloring options (e.g.,
8310 executable, orphan, sticky, other-writable, capability), use
8311 @command{dircolors} to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment variable like this,
8313 eval $(dircolors -p | perl -pe \
8314 's/^((CAP|S[ET]|O[TR]|M|E)\w+).*/$1 00/' | dircolors -)
8316 and on a @code{dirent.d_type}-capable file system, @command{ls}
8317 will perform only one @code{stat} call per command line argument.
8320 @itemx --classify [=@var{when}]
8321 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
8324 @opindex --indicator-style
8325 @cindex file type and executables, marking
8326 @cindex executables and file type, marking
8327 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
8328 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
8329 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
8330 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
8331 and nothing for regular files.
8332 @var{when} may be omitted, or one of:
8335 @vindex none @r{classify option}
8336 - Do not classify. This is the default.
8338 @vindex auto @r{classify option}
8339 @cindex terminal, using classify iff
8340 - Only classify if standard output is a terminal.
8342 @vindex always @r{classify option}
8345 Specifying @option{--classify} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
8346 @option{--classify=always}.
8347 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
8348 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
8349 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
8350 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
8351 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
8354 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
8355 @opindex --file-type
8356 @opindex --indicator-style
8357 @cindex file type, marking
8358 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
8359 like @option{--classify} (@option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
8361 @item --hyperlink [=@var{when}]
8362 @opindex --hyperlink
8363 @cindex hyperlink, linking to files
8364 Output codes recognized by some terminals to link
8365 to files using the @samp{file://} URI format.
8366 @var{when} may be omitted, or one of:
8369 @vindex none @r{hyperlink option}
8370 - Do not use hyperlinks at all. This is the default.
8372 @vindex auto @r{hyperlink option}
8373 @cindex terminal, using hyperlink iff
8374 - Only use hyperlinks if standard output is a terminal.
8376 @vindex always @r{hyperlink option}
8377 - Always use hyperlinks.
8379 Specifying @option{--hyperlink} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
8380 @option{--hyperlink=always}.
8382 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
8383 @opindex --indicator-style
8384 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
8389 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
8391 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
8394 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
8395 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
8396 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
8398 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
8399 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{--classify}
8400 (@option{-F}) option.
8406 @opindex --kibibytes
8407 Set the default block size to its normal value of 1024 bytes,
8408 overriding any contrary specification in environment variables
8409 (@pxref{Block size}). If @option{--block-size},
8410 @option{--human-readable} (@option{-h}), or @option{--si} options are used,
8411 they take precedence even if @option{--kibibytes} (@option{-k}) is placed after
8413 The @option{--kibibytes} (@option{-k}) option affects the
8414 per-directory block count written in long format,
8415 and the file system allocation written by the @option{--size} (@option{-s})
8416 option. It does not affect the file size in bytes that is written in
8420 @itemx --format=commas
8423 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
8424 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
8425 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space),
8426 and with no other information.
8429 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
8431 @opindex --indicator-style
8432 @cindex file type, marking
8433 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
8436 @itemx --format=across
8437 @itemx --format=horizontal
8440 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
8441 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
8442 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
8445 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
8448 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
8449 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
8450 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
8452 Some terminal emulators might not properly align columns to the right of a
8453 TAB following a non-ASCII byte. You can avoid that issue by using the
8454 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment, to tell
8455 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
8457 If you set a terminal's hardware tabs to anything other than the default,
8458 you should also use a @command{--tabsize} option or @env{TABSIZE}
8459 environment variable either to match the hardware tabs, or to disable
8460 the use of hardware tabs. Otherwise, the output of @command{ls} may
8461 not line up. For example, if you run the shell command @samp{tabs -4}
8462 to set hardware tabs to every four columns, you should also run
8463 @samp{export TABSIZE=4} or @samp{export TABSIZE=0}, or use the
8464 corresponding @option{--tabsize} options.
8467 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
8471 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
8472 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
8473 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
8474 is 80. With a @var{cols} value of @samp{0}, there is no limit on
8475 the length of the output line, and that single output line will
8476 be delimited with spaces, not tabs.
8481 This option is incompatible with the @option{--dired} (@option{-D}) option.
8482 This option also implies the options @option{--show-control-chars},
8483 @option{-1}, @option{--color=none}, and
8484 @option{--quoting-style=literal} (@option{-N}).
8489 @node Formatting file timestamps
8490 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
8492 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form, using
8493 a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2020} for non-recent timestamps, and a
8494 date-without-year and time like @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
8495 This format can change depending on the current locale as detailed below.
8498 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
8499 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
8500 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
8501 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
8502 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
8503 @xref{File timestamps}.
8506 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
8507 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
8508 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
8509 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8511 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
8514 @item --time-style=@var{style}
8515 @opindex --time-style
8517 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
8518 be one of the following:
8523 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
8524 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
8525 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
8526 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2020-03-30 23:45:56}. As
8527 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
8528 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
8530 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
8531 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
8532 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
8533 spaces in one of the two formats.
8536 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601-like date, time, and time zone
8537 components with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21
8538 23:45:56.477817180 -0400}. This style is equivalent to
8539 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
8541 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
8542 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
8543 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since GNU @command{make}
8544 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
8547 List ISO 8601 date and time components with minute precision, e.g.,
8548 @samp{2020-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
8549 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
8550 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
8553 List ISO 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
8554 @samp{2020-03-30@ }), and ISO 8601-like month, day, hour, and
8555 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
8556 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
8557 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
8558 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
8559 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
8564 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
8565 ls -l --time-style="iso"
8570 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a French
8571 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{30 mars@ @ @ 2020}
8572 and recent timestamps like @samp{30 mars@ @ 23:45}. Locale-dependent
8573 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
8574 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
8575 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
8577 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
8578 default POSIX locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
8579 @ 2020} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
8580 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
8585 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
8586 ls -l --time-style="locale"
8589 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
8590 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
8591 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
8592 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2020@ } and
8593 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
8595 @item posix-@var{style}
8597 List POSIX-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
8598 category is POSIX, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
8599 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
8600 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2020} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
8601 the POSIX locale, and like @samp{2020-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
8606 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
8607 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
8608 the default style is @samp{locale}. GNU Emacs 21.3 and
8609 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
8610 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
8611 non-POSIX locale you may need to set
8612 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
8614 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
8615 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
8618 @node Formatting the file names
8619 @subsection Formatting the file names
8621 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
8627 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
8630 @opindex --quoting-style
8631 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
8632 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
8633 backslash sequences like those used in C.
8637 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
8640 @opindex --quoting-style
8641 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
8642 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
8643 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
8647 @itemx --hide-control-chars
8649 @opindex --hide-control-chars
8650 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
8651 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
8656 @itemx --quoting-style=c
8658 @opindex --quote-name
8659 @opindex --quoting-style
8660 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
8663 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
8664 @opindex --quoting-style
8665 @cindex quoting style
8666 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
8667 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
8668 be one of the following:
8670 @macro quotingStyles
8673 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{--literal} (@option{-N})
8676 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
8677 cause ambiguous output.
8678 The quoting is suitable for POSIX-compatible shells like
8679 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
8682 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
8684 Like @samp{shell}, but also quoting non-printable characters using the POSIX
8685 proposed @samp{$''} syntax suitable for most shells.
8686 @item shell-escape-always
8687 Like @samp{shell-escape}, but quote strings even if they would
8688 normally not require quoting.
8690 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
8691 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
8692 @option{--quote-name} (@option{-Q}) option.
8694 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
8695 surrounding double-quote
8696 characters; this is the same as the @option{--escape} (@option{-b}) option.
8698 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
8699 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
8702 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
8703 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
8704 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
8705 @t{'like this'} instead of @t{"like
8706 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
8711 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
8712 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. If that environment
8713 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{shell-escape} when the
8714 output is a terminal, and @samp{literal} otherwise.
8716 @item --show-control-chars
8717 @opindex --show-control-chars
8718 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
8719 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
8725 @node dir invocation
8726 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
8729 @cindex directory listing, brief
8731 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
8732 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
8733 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
8735 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
8738 @node vdir invocation
8739 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
8742 @cindex directory listing, verbose
8744 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
8745 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
8746 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
8748 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
8750 @node dircolors invocation
8751 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
8755 @cindex setup for color
8757 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
8758 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
8762 eval "$(dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}])"
8765 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
8766 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
8767 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
8768 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
8770 To make @command{dircolors} read a @file{~/.dircolors} file if it
8771 exists, you can put the following lines in your @file{~/.bashrc} (or
8772 adapt them to your favorite shell):
8776 test -r $d && eval "$(dircolors $d)"
8780 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
8781 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
8782 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
8783 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
8784 environment variable.
8786 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8791 @itemx --bourne-shell
8794 @opindex --bourne-shell
8795 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
8796 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
8797 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
8798 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
8807 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
8808 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
8809 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
8810 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
8813 @itemx --print-database
8815 @opindex --print-database
8816 @cindex color database, printing
8817 @cindex database for color setup, printing
8818 @cindex printing color database
8819 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
8820 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
8821 of the possibilities.
8823 @item --print-ls-colors
8824 @opindex --print-ls-colors
8825 @cindex printing ls colors
8826 Print the LS_COLORS entries on separate lines,
8827 each colored as per the color they represent.
8834 @node Basic operations
8835 @chapter Basic operations
8837 @cindex manipulating files
8839 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
8840 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
8843 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
8844 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
8845 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
8846 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
8847 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
8848 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
8853 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
8856 @cindex copying files and directories
8857 @cindex files, copying
8858 @cindex directories, copying
8860 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
8861 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
8862 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
8866 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
8867 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
8868 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
8873 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
8877 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8878 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8879 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8880 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
8881 using the @var{source}s' names.
8884 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
8885 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
8887 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
8888 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
8889 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
8890 to corresponding destination directories.
8892 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
8893 link only when not copying recursively or when @option{--link}
8894 (@option{-l}) is used. This default can be overridden with the
8895 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
8896 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
8897 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
8898 the last one silently overrides the others.
8900 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} follows the
8901 link only when it refers to an existing regular file.
8902 However, when copying to a dangling symbolic link, @command{cp}
8903 refuses by default, and fails with a diagnostic, since the operation
8904 is inherently dangerous. This behavior is contrary to historical
8905 practice and to POSIX@.
8906 Set @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} to make @command{cp} attempt to create
8907 the target of a dangling destination symlink, in spite of the possible risk.
8908 Also, when an option like
8909 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
8910 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
8911 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
8913 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
8914 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
8915 @option{--copy-contents} option.
8917 @cindex self-backups
8918 @cindex backups, making only
8919 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
8920 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
8921 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
8922 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
8923 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
8924 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
8926 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8933 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
8934 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
8935 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
8936 directory in a different order).
8937 Try to preserve SELinux security context and extended attributes (xattr),
8938 but ignore any failure to do that and print no corresponding diagnostic.
8939 Equivalent to @option{-dR --preserve=all} with the reduced diagnostics.
8941 @item --attributes-only
8942 @opindex --attributes-only
8943 Copy only the specified attributes of the source file to the destination.
8944 If the destination already exists, do not alter its contents.
8945 See the @option{--preserve} option for controlling which attributes to copy.
8948 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
8951 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
8952 @cindex backups, making
8953 @xref{Backup options}.
8954 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
8955 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
8956 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
8957 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
8958 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
8962 # Usage: backup FILE...
8963 # Create a GNU-style backup of each listed FILE.
8966 cp --backup --force --preserve=all -- "$i" "$i" || fail=1
8971 @item --copy-contents
8972 @cindex directories, copying recursively
8973 @cindex copying directories recursively
8974 @cindex recursively copying directories
8975 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
8976 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
8977 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
8978 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
8979 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
8980 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
8981 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
8982 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
8983 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
8984 fill up your destination file system if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
8985 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
8986 affect the copying of symbolic links.
8990 @cindex symbolic links, copying
8991 @cindex hard links, preserving
8992 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
8993 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
8994 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
8999 @cindex debugging, copying
9000 Print extra information to stdout, explaining how files are copied.
9001 This option implies the @option{--verbose} option.
9009 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
9010 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force},
9011 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then
9012 tries to recreate the file by first removing it. The @option{--force} option
9013 alone will not remove dangling symlinks.
9014 When this option is combined with
9015 @option{--link} (@option{-l}) or @option{--symbolic-link}
9016 (@option{-s}), the destination link is replaced, and unless
9017 @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) is also given there is no brief
9018 moment when the destination does not exist. Also see the
9019 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
9021 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
9022 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
9024 This option is ignored when the @option{--no-clobber} or @option{-n} option
9029 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
9030 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
9031 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
9032 via recursive traversal.
9035 @itemx --interactive
9037 @opindex --interactive
9038 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
9039 overwrite an existing destination file, and fail if the response
9040 is not affirmative. The @option{-i} option overrides
9041 a previous @option{-n} option.
9047 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
9050 @itemx --dereference
9052 @opindex --dereference
9053 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
9054 With this option, @command{cp} cannot create a symbolic link.
9055 For example, a symlink (to regular file) in the source tree will be copied to
9056 a regular file in the destination tree.
9061 @opindex --no-clobber
9062 Do not overwrite an existing file; silently skip instead.
9063 This option overrides a previous @option{-i} option.
9064 This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or @option{--backup} option.
9065 This option is deprecated due to having a different exit status from
9066 other platforms. See also the @option{--update} option which will
9067 give more control over how to deal with existing files in the destination,
9068 and over the exit status in particular.
9071 @itemx --no-dereference
9073 @opindex --no-dereference
9074 @cindex symbolic links, copying
9075 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
9076 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
9077 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
9080 @itemx --preserve[=@var{attribute_list}]
9083 @cindex file information, preserving, extended attributes, xattr
9084 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
9085 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
9086 of one or more of the following strings:
9090 @cindex access control lists (ACLs)
9091 Preserve attributes relevant to access permissions,
9092 including file mode bits and (if possible) access control lists (ACLs).
9093 ACL preservation is system-dependent, and ACLs are not necessarily
9094 translated when the source and destination are on file systems with
9095 different ACL formats (e.g., NFSv4 versus POSIX formats).
9098 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
9099 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
9101 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
9102 a member of the desired group.
9104 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
9105 On older systems, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
9106 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
9107 However, many systems now provide the @code{utimensat} function,
9108 which makes it possible even for symbolic links.
9110 Preserve in the destination files
9111 any links between corresponding source files.
9112 With @option{-L} or @option{-H}, this option can convert
9113 symbolic links to hard links. For example,
9115 $ mkdir c; : > a; ln -s a b; cp -aH a b c; ls -i1 c
9120 Although @file{b} is a symlink to regular file @file{a},
9121 the files in the destination directory @file{c/} are hard-linked.
9122 Since @option{-a} implies @option{--no-dereference} it would copy the symlink,
9123 but the later @option{-H} tells @command{cp} to dereference the command line
9124 arguments where it then sees two files with the same inode number.
9125 Then the @option{--preserve=links} option also implied by @option{-a}
9126 will preserve the perceived hard link.
9128 Here is a similar example that exercises @command{cp}'s @option{-L} option:
9130 $ mkdir b c; (cd b; : > a; ln -s a b); cp -aL b c; ls -i1 c/b
9136 Preserve SELinux security context of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
9138 @cindex access control lists (ACLs)
9139 Preserve extended attributes of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
9140 If @command{cp} is built without xattr support, ignore this option.
9141 If SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities are implemented using xattrs,
9142 they are preserved implicitly by this option as well, i.e., even without
9143 specifying @option{--preserve=mode} or @option{--preserve=context}.
9145 Preserve all file attributes.
9146 Equivalent to specifying all of the above, but with the difference
9147 that failure to preserve SELinux security context or extended attributes
9148 does not change @command{cp}'s exit status. In contrast to @option{-a},
9149 all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
9152 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
9153 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
9155 In the absence of this option, the permissions of existing destination
9156 files are unchanged. Each new file is created with the mode of the
9157 corresponding source file minus the set-user-ID, set-group-ID, and
9158 sticky bits as the create mode; the operating system then applies either
9159 the umask or a default ACL, possibly resulting in a more restrictive
9161 @xref{File permissions}.
9163 @item --no-preserve=@var{attribute_list}
9164 @cindex file information, preserving
9165 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
9166 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
9170 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
9171 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
9172 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
9173 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
9174 For example, the command:
9177 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
9181 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
9182 any missing intermediate directories.
9189 @opindex --recursive
9190 @cindex directories, copying recursively
9191 @cindex copying directories recursively
9192 @cindex recursively copying directories
9193 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
9194 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
9195 links in the source unless used together with the @option{--link}
9196 (@option{-l}) option; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
9197 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
9198 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
9199 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
9200 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
9201 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
9202 non-GNU systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
9203 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
9204 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
9205 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as POSIX allows
9206 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
9208 @item --reflink[=@var{when}]
9209 @opindex --reflink[=@var{when}]
9212 @cindex copy on write
9213 Perform a lightweight, copy-on-write (COW) copy, if supported by the
9214 file system. Once it has succeeded, beware that the source and destination
9215 files share the same data blocks as long as they remain unmodified.
9216 Thus, if an I/O error affects data blocks of one of the files,
9217 the other suffers the same fate.
9219 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
9223 If the copy-on-write operation is not supported
9224 then report the failure for each file and exit with a failure status.
9225 Plain @option{--reflink} is equivalent to @option{--reflink=always}.
9228 If the copy-on-write operation is not supported then fall back
9229 to the standard copy behavior.
9230 This is the default if no @option{--reflink} option is given.
9233 Disable copy-on-write operation and use the standard copy behavior.
9236 This option is overridden by the @option{--link}, @option{--symbolic-link}
9237 and @option{--attributes-only} options, thus allowing it to be used
9238 to configure the default data copying behavior for @command{cp}.
9240 @item --remove-destination
9241 @opindex --remove-destination
9242 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
9243 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
9245 @item --sparse=@var{when}
9246 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
9247 @cindex sparse files, copying
9248 @cindex holes, copying files with
9249 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
9250 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes} -- a sequence of zero bytes that
9251 does not occupy any file system blocks; the @samp{read} system call
9252 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable space and
9253 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
9254 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
9255 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
9256 Only regular files may be sparse.
9258 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
9262 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
9263 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
9264 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
9267 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
9268 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
9269 input file does not appear to be sparse.
9270 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
9271 that does not support sparse files
9272 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
9273 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
9274 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
9275 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
9278 Never make the output file sparse.
9279 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
9280 since such a file must not have any holes.
9283 For example, with the following alias, @command{cp} will use the
9284 minimum amount of space supported by the file system.
9285 (Older versions of @command{cp} can also benefit from
9286 @option{--reflink=auto} here.)
9289 alias cp='cp --sparse=always'
9292 @optStripTrailingSlashes
9295 @itemx --symbolic-link
9297 @opindex --symbolic-link
9298 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
9299 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
9300 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
9301 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
9302 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
9308 @optNoTargetDirectory
9311 @itemx --update[=@var{which}]
9313 @opindex --update[=@var{which}]
9314 @cindex newer files, copying only
9315 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
9316 same or newer modification timestamp; instead, silently skip the file
9317 without failing. If timestamps are being preserved,
9318 the comparison is to the source timestamp truncated to the
9319 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
9320 used to update timestamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
9321 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and destination.
9322 This option is ignored if the @option{-n} or @option{--no-clobber}
9323 option is also specified.
9324 Also, if @option{--preserve=links} is also specified (like with @samp{cp -au}
9325 for example), that will take precedence; consequently, depending on the
9326 order that files are processed from the source, newer files in the destination
9327 may be replaced, to mirror hard links in the source.
9330 @var{which} gives more control over which existing files in the
9331 destination are replaced, and its value can be one of the following:
9335 This is the default operation when an @option{--update} option is not specified,
9336 and results in all existing files in the destination being replaced.
9339 This is like the deprecated @option{--no-clobber} option, where no files in the
9340 destination are replaced, and also skipping a file does not induce a failure.
9343 This is similar to @samp{none}, in that no files in the destination
9344 are replaced, but any skipped files are diagnosed and induce a failure.
9347 This is the default operation when @option{--update} is specified, and results
9348 in files being replaced if they're older than the corresponding source file.
9357 Print the name of each file before copying it.
9360 @itemx --one-file-system
9362 @opindex --one-file-system
9363 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
9364 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
9365 the copy started on.
9366 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
9370 @itemx --context[=@var{context}]
9373 @cindex SELinux, setting/restoring security context
9374 @cindex security context
9375 Without a specified @var{context}, adjust the SELinux security context according
9376 to the system default type for destination files, similarly to the
9377 @command{restorecon} command.
9378 The long form of this option with a specific context specified,
9379 will set the context for newly created files only.
9380 With a specified context, if both SELinux and SMACK are disabled, a warning is
9384 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve=context}
9385 option, and overrides the @option{--preserve=all} and @option{-a} options.
9393 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
9396 @cindex converting while copying a file
9398 @command{dd} copies input to output with a changeable I/O block size,
9399 while optionally performing conversions on the data. Synopses:
9402 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
9406 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
9407 @xref{Common options}.
9409 By default, @command{dd} copies standard input to standard output.
9410 To copy, @command{dd} repeatedly does the following steps in order:
9414 Read an input block.
9417 If converting via @samp{sync}, pad as needed to meet the input block size.
9418 Pad with spaces if converting via @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, NUL
9422 If @samp{bs=} is given and no conversion mentioned in steps (4) or (5)
9423 is given, output the data as a single block and skip all remaining steps.
9426 If the @samp{swab} conversion is given, swap each pair of input bytes.
9427 If the input data length is odd, preserve the last input byte
9428 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
9431 If any of the conversions @samp{swab}, @samp{block}, @samp{unblock},
9432 @samp{lcase}, @samp{ucase}, @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic} and @samp{ibm}
9433 are given, do these conversions. These conversions operate
9434 independently of input blocking, and might deal with records that span
9438 Aggregate the resulting data into output blocks of the specified size,
9439 and output each output block in turn. Do not pad the last output block;
9440 it can be shorter than usual.
9443 @command{dd} accepts the following operands,
9444 whose syntax was inspired by the DD (data definition) statement of
9451 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
9455 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
9456 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, truncate @var{file} before writing it.
9458 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
9460 @cindex block size of input
9461 @cindex input block size
9462 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
9463 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
9464 The default is 512 bytes.
9466 @item obs=@var{bytes}
9468 @cindex block size of output
9469 @cindex output block size
9470 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
9471 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
9472 The default is 512 bytes.
9474 @item bs=@var{bytes}
9477 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
9478 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
9479 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
9480 In addition, if no data-transforming @option{conv} operand is specified,
9481 input is copied to the output as soon as it's read,
9482 even if it is smaller than the block size.
9484 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
9486 @cindex block size of conversion
9487 @cindex conversion block size
9488 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
9489 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
9490 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
9491 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
9492 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
9493 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
9496 @itemx iseek=@var{n}
9499 Skip @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
9500 If @var{n} ends in the letter @samp{B}, interpret @var{n}
9501 as a byte count rather than a block count.
9502 (@samp{B} and the @samp{iseek=} spelling are GNU extensions to POSIX.)
9505 @itemx oseek=@var{n}
9508 Skip @var{n} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before
9509 truncating or copying.
9510 If @var{n} ends in the letter @samp{B}, interpret @var{n}
9511 as a byte count rather than a block count.
9512 (@samp{B} and the @samp{oseek=} spelling are GNU extensions to POSIX.)
9516 Copy @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
9517 of everything until the end of the file.
9518 If @var{n} ends in the letter @samp{B},
9519 interpret @var{n} as a byte count rather than a block count;
9520 this is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9521 If short reads occur, as could be the case
9522 when reading from a pipe for example, @samp{iflag=fullblock}
9523 ensures that @samp{count=} counts complete input blocks
9524 rather than input read operations.
9525 As an extension to POSIX, @samp{count=0} copies zero blocks
9526 instead of copying all blocks.
9528 @item status=@var{level}
9530 Specify the amount of information printed.
9531 If this operand is given multiple times, the last one takes precedence.
9532 The @var{level} value can be one of the following:
9537 @opindex none @r{dd status=}
9538 Do not print any informational or warning messages to standard error.
9539 Error messages are output as normal.
9542 @opindex noxfer @r{dd status=}
9543 Do not print the final transfer rate and volume statistics
9544 that normally make up the last status line.
9547 @opindex progress @r{dd status=}
9548 Print the transfer rate and volume statistics on standard error,
9549 when processing each input block. Statistics are output
9550 on a single line at most once every second, but updates
9551 can be delayed when waiting on I/O.
9555 Transfer information is normally output to standard error upon
9556 receipt of the @samp{INFO} signal or when @command{dd} exits,
9557 and defaults to the following form in the C locale:
9561 116608+0 records out
9562 59703296 bytes (60 MB, 57 MiB) copied, 0.0427974 s, 1.4 GB/s
9565 The notation @samp{@var{w}+@var{p}} stands for @var{w} whole blocks
9566 and @var{p} partial blocks. A partial block occurs when a read or
9567 write operation succeeds but transfers less data than the block size.
9568 An additional line like @samp{1 truncated record} or @samp{10
9569 truncated records} is output after the @samp{records out} line if
9570 @samp{conv=block} processing truncated one or more input records.
9572 The @samp{status=} operand is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9574 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
9576 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
9577 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
9584 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
9585 Convert EBCDIC to ASCII,
9586 using the conversion table specified by POSIX@.
9587 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
9588 This implies @samp{conv=unblock}; input is converted to
9589 ASCII before trailing spaces are deleted.
9592 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
9593 Convert ASCII to EBCDIC@.
9594 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
9595 This implies @samp{conv=block}; trailing spaces are added
9596 before being converted to EBCDIC@.
9599 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
9600 This acts like @samp{conv=ebcdic}, except it
9601 uses the alternate conversion table specified by POSIX@.
9602 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
9603 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
9605 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
9606 mutually exclusive. If you use any of these conversions, you should also
9607 use the @samp{cbs=} operand.
9610 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
9611 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
9612 input newline with a space and truncating or padding input lines with
9613 spaces as necessary.
9617 Remove any trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block,
9618 and append a newline.
9620 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
9621 If you use either of these conversions, you should also use the
9622 @samp{cbs=} operand.
9625 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
9626 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
9629 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
9630 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
9632 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
9636 Try to seek rather than write NUL output blocks.
9637 On a file system that supports sparse files, this will create
9638 sparse output when extending the output file.
9639 Be careful when using this conversion in conjunction with
9640 @samp{conv=notrunc} or @samp{oflag=append}.
9641 With @samp{conv=notrunc}, existing data in the output file
9642 corresponding to NUL blocks from the input, will be untouched.
9643 With @samp{oflag=append} the seeks performed will be ineffective.
9644 Similarly, when the output is a device rather than a file,
9645 NUL input blocks are not copied, and therefore this conversion
9646 is most useful with virtual or pre zeroed devices.
9648 The @samp{sparse} conversion is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9651 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
9652 @cindex byte-swapping
9653 Swap every pair of input bytes.
9656 @opindex sync @r{(padding with ASCII NULs)}
9657 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
9658 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
9663 The following ``conversions'' are really file flags
9664 and don't affect internal processing:
9669 @cindex creating output file, requiring
9670 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
9675 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
9676 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
9678 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive,
9679 and are GNU extensions to POSIX.
9683 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
9684 Do not truncate the output file.
9688 @cindex read errors, ignoring
9689 Continue after read errors.
9693 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
9694 Synchronize output data just before finishing,
9695 even if there were write errors.
9696 This forces a physical write of output data,
9697 so that even if power is lost the output data will be preserved.
9698 If neither this nor @samp{fsync} are specified, output is treated as
9699 usual with file systems, i.e., output data and metadata may be cached
9700 in primary memory for some time before the operating system physically
9701 writes it, and thus output data and metadata may be lost if power is lost.
9702 @xref{sync invocation}.
9703 This conversion is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9707 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
9708 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing,
9709 even if there were write errors.
9710 This acts like @samp{fdatasync} except it also preserves output metadata,
9711 such as the last-modified time of the output file; for this reason it
9712 may be a bit slower than @samp{fdatasync} although the performance
9713 difference is typically insignificant for @command{dd}.
9714 This conversion is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9718 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
9720 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
9721 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
9723 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
9725 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
9726 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
9734 @cindex appending to the output file
9735 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
9736 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
9737 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
9738 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
9739 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
9740 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
9744 @cindex concurrent I/O
9745 Use concurrent I/O mode for data. This mode performs direct I/O
9746 and drops the POSIX requirement to serialize all I/O to the same file.
9747 A file cannot be opened in CIO mode and with a standard open at the
9753 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
9754 The kernel may impose restrictions on read or write buffer sizes.
9755 For example, with an ext4 destination file system and a Linux-based kernel,
9756 using @samp{oflag=direct} will cause writes to fail with @code{EINVAL} if the
9757 output buffer size is not a multiple of 512.
9761 @cindex directory I/O
9763 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
9764 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
9768 @cindex synchronized data reads
9769 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
9770 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
9771 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
9772 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
9773 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
9777 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
9778 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
9782 @cindex discarding file cache
9783 Request to discard the system data cache for a file.
9784 When count=0 all cached data for the file is specified,
9785 otherwise the cache is dropped for the processed
9786 portion of the file. Also when count=0,
9787 failure to discard the cache is diagnosed
9788 and reflected in the exit status.
9790 Because data not already persisted to storage is not discarded from the cache,
9791 the @samp{sync} conversions in the following examples maximize the
9792 effectiveness of the @samp{nocache} flag.
9794 Here are some usage examples:
9797 # Advise to drop cache for whole file
9798 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache count=0
9800 # Ensure drop cache for the whole file
9801 dd of=ofile oflag=nocache conv=notrunc,fdatasync count=0
9803 # Advise to drop cache for part of file
9804 # The kernel will consider only complete and
9805 # already persisted pages.
9806 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache skip=10 count=10 of=/dev/null
9808 # Stream data using just the read-ahead cache.
9809 # See also the @samp{direct} flag.
9810 dd if=ifile of=ofile iflag=nocache oflag=nocache,sync
9815 @cindex nonblocking I/O
9816 Use non-blocking I/O.
9820 @cindex access timestamp
9821 Do not update the file's access timestamp.
9822 @xref{File timestamps}.
9823 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
9824 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
9828 @cindex controlling terminal
9829 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
9830 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
9831 On many hosts (e.g., GNU/Linux hosts), this flag has no effect
9836 @cindex symbolic links, following
9837 Do not follow symbolic links.
9842 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
9847 Use binary I/O@. This flag has an effect only on nonstandard
9848 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
9853 Use text I/O@. Like @samp{binary}, this flag has no effect on
9858 Accumulate full blocks from input. The @code{read} system call
9859 may return early if a full block is not available.
9860 When that happens, continue calling @code{read} to fill the remainder
9862 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
9863 This flag is useful with pipes for example
9864 as they may return short reads. In that case,
9865 this flag is needed to ensure that a @samp{count=} argument is
9866 interpreted as a block count rather than a count of read operations.
9870 These flags are all GNU extensions to POSIX.
9871 They are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
9872 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
9873 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
9874 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
9875 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
9876 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
9880 The behavior of @command{dd} is unspecified if operands other than
9881 @samp{conv=}, @samp{iflag=}, @samp{oflag=}, and @samp{status=} are
9882 specified more than once.
9884 @cindex multipliers after numbers
9885 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{n} and @var{bytes})
9886 are unsigned decimal integers that
9887 can be followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
9888 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
9889 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
9890 These multipliers are GNU extensions to POSIX, except that
9891 POSIX allows @var{bytes} to be followed by @samp{k}, @samp{b}, and
9892 @samp{x@var{m}}. An @samp{x@var{m}} can be used more than once in a number.
9893 Block sizes (i.e., specified by @var{bytes} strings) must be nonzero.
9895 Any block size you specify via @samp{bs=}, @samp{ibs=}, @samp{obs=}, @samp{cbs=}
9896 should not be too large -- values larger than a few megabytes
9897 are generally wasteful or (as in the gigabyte..exabyte case) downright
9898 counterproductive or error-inducing.
9900 To process data with offset or size that is not a multiple of the I/O
9901 block size, you can use a numeric string @var{n} that ends in the
9903 For example, the following shell commands copy data
9904 in 1 MiB blocks between a flash drive and a tape, but do not save
9905 or restore a 512-byte area at the start of the flash drive:
9911 # Copy all but the initial 512 bytes from flash to tape.
9912 dd if=$flash iseek=512B bs=1MiB of=$tape
9914 # Copy from tape back to flash, leaving initial 512 bytes alone.
9915 dd if=$tape bs=1MiB of=$flash oseek=512B
9919 @cindex storage devices, failing
9920 For failing storage devices, other tools come with a great variety of extra
9921 functionality to ease the saving of as much data as possible before the
9922 device finally dies, e.g.
9923 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/software/ddrescue/, GNU @command{ddrescue}}.
9924 However, in some cases such a tool is not available or the administrator
9925 feels more comfortable with the handling of @command{dd}.
9926 As a simple rescue method, call @command{dd} as shown in the following
9927 example: the operand @samp{conv=noerror,sync} is used to continue
9928 after read errors and to pad out bad reads with NULs, while
9929 @samp{iflag=fullblock} caters for short reads (which traditionally never
9930 occur on flash or similar devices):
9933 # Rescue data from an (unmounted!) partition of a failing device.
9934 dd conv=noerror,sync iflag=fullblock </dev/sda1 > /mnt/rescue.img
9937 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal (or @samp{USR1} signal where that is unavailable)
9938 to a running @command{dd} process makes it print I/O statistics to
9939 standard error and then resume copying. In the example below,
9940 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 5GB of data.
9941 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
9942 and when @command{dd} completes normally or is killed by the
9943 @code{SIGINT} signal, it outputs the final statistics.
9946 # Ignore the signal so we never inadvertently terminate the dd child.
9947 # (This is not needed when SIGINFO is available.)
9950 # Run dd with the fullblock iflag to avoid short reads
9951 # which can be triggered by reception of signals.
9952 dd iflag=fullblock if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=5000000 bs=1000 & pid=$!
9954 # Output stats every second.
9955 while kill -s USR1 $pid 2>/dev/null; do sleep 1; done
9958 The above script will output in the following format:
9961 3441325+0 records in
9962 3441325+0 records out
9963 3441325000 bytes (3.4 GB, 3.2 GiB) copied, 1.00036 s, 3.4 GB/s
9964 5000000+0 records in
9965 5000000+0 records out
9966 5000000000 bytes (5.0 GB, 4.7 GiB) copied, 1.44433 s, 3.5 GB/s
9969 The @samp{status=progress} operand periodically updates the last line
9970 of the transfer statistics above.
9972 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
9973 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
9974 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
9975 environment variable is set.
9980 @node install invocation
9981 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
9984 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
9986 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
9987 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
9990 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
9991 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
9992 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
9993 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
9998 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
10002 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
10003 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
10004 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
10005 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
10006 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
10009 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
10010 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
10011 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
10012 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
10013 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
10014 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
10017 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
10018 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
10019 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
10020 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
10021 files onto themselves.
10023 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
10024 @command{install} never preserves extended attributes (xattr).
10026 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10036 Compare content of source and destination files, and if there would be no
10037 change to the destination content, owner, group, permissions, and possibly
10038 SELinux context, then do not modify the destination at all.
10039 This option is best used in conjunction with @option{--user},
10040 @option{--group} and @option{--mode} options, lest @command{install}
10041 incorrectly determines the default attributes that installed files would have
10042 (as it doesn't consider setgid directories and POSIX default ACLs for example).
10043 This could result in redundant copies or attributes that are not reset to the
10048 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
10052 Create any missing parent directories of @var{dest},
10053 then copy @var{source} to @var{dest}.
10054 Explicitly specifying the @option{--target-directory=@var{dir}} will similarly
10055 ensure the presence of that hierarchy before copying @var{source} arguments.
10060 @opindex --directory
10061 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
10062 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
10063 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
10064 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
10065 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
10066 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
10070 @item -g @var{group}
10071 @itemx --group=@var{group}
10074 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
10075 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
10076 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
10077 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
10079 @item -m @var{mode}
10080 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
10083 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
10084 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
10085 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
10086 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
10087 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
10088 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s} -- read, write, and
10089 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
10090 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
10091 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
10092 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
10093 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
10095 @item -o @var{owner}
10096 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
10099 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
10100 @cindex appropriate privileges
10101 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
10102 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
10103 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
10104 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
10107 @item --preserve-context
10108 @opindex --preserve-context
10110 @cindex security context
10111 Preserve the SELinux security context of files and directories.
10112 Failure to preserve the context in all of the files or directories
10113 will result in an exit status of 1. If SELinux is disabled then
10114 print a warning and ignore the option.
10117 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
10119 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
10120 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
10121 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
10122 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
10123 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
10124 last modification timestamps are both set to the time of installation.
10125 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification timestamps
10126 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
10127 to when they were last installed.
10133 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
10134 @cindex stripping symbol table information
10135 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
10137 @item --strip-program=@var{program}
10138 @opindex --strip-program
10139 @cindex symbol table information, stripping, program
10140 Program used to strip binaries.
10144 @optTargetDirectory
10145 Also specifying the @option{-D} option will ensure the directory is present.
10147 @optNoTargetDirectory
10153 Print the name of each file before copying it.
10156 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve-context} option.
10164 @node mv invocation
10165 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
10169 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
10172 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
10173 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
10174 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
10179 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
10183 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
10184 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
10185 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
10186 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
10187 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
10190 To move a file, @command{mv} ordinarily simply renames it.
10191 However, if renaming does not work because the destination's file
10192 system differs, @command{mv} falls back on copying as if by @code{cp -a},
10193 then (assuming the copy succeeded) it removes the original.
10194 If the copy fails, then @command{mv} removes any partially created
10195 copy in the destination. If you were to copy three directories from
10196 one file system to another and the copy of the first
10197 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
10198 the destination file system and the second and third would be left on the
10199 original file system.
10201 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
10202 @command{mv} always tries to copy extended attributes (xattr), which may
10203 include SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities.
10204 Upon failure all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
10206 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
10207 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
10208 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
10209 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
10210 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
10211 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
10213 Avoid specifying a source name with a trailing slash,
10214 when it might be a symlink to a directory.
10215 Otherwise, @command{mv} may do something very surprising, since
10216 its behavior depends on the underlying rename system call.
10217 On a system with a modern Linux-based kernel, it fails with
10218 @code{errno=ENOTDIR}@.
10219 However, on other systems (at least FreeBSD 6.1 and Solaris 10) it silently
10220 renames not the symlink but rather the directory referenced by the symlink.
10221 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
10223 The @command{mv} command replaces destination directories only if they
10224 are empty. Conflicting populated directories are skipped with a diagnostic.
10226 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10238 @cindex prompts, omitting
10239 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
10241 If you specify more than one of the @option{-i}, @option{-f}, @option{-n}
10242 options, only the final one takes effect.
10247 @itemx --interactive
10249 @opindex --interactive
10250 @cindex prompts, forcing
10251 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
10252 of its permissions, and fail if the response is not affirmative.
10256 @itemx --no-clobber
10258 @opindex --no-clobber
10259 @cindex prompts, omitting
10260 Do not overwrite an existing file; silently fail instead.
10262 This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or @option{--backup} option.
10263 See also the @option{--update=none} option which will
10264 skip existing files but not fail.
10268 @cindex renaming files without copying them
10269 If a file cannot be renamed because the destination file system differs,
10270 fail with a diagnostic instead of copying and then removing the file.
10276 @cindex newer files, moving only
10277 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
10278 same or newer modification timestamp;
10279 instead, silently skip the file without failing.
10280 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
10281 source timestamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
10282 system and of the system calls used to update timestamps; this avoids
10283 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
10284 same source and destination.
10285 This option is ignored if the @option{-n} or @option{--no-clobber}
10286 option is also specified.
10294 Print the name of each file before moving it.
10296 @item --keep-directory-symlink
10297 @opindex --keep-directory-symlink
10298 Follow existing symlinks to directories when copying.
10299 Use this option only when the destination directory's contents are trusted,
10300 as an attacker can place symlinks in the destination
10301 to cause @command{cp} write to arbitrary target directories.
10303 @optStripTrailingSlashes
10307 @optTargetDirectory
10309 @optNoTargetDirectory
10315 @cindex SELinux, restoring security context
10316 @cindex security context
10317 This option functions similarly to the @command{restorecon} command,
10318 by adjusting the SELinux security context according
10319 to the system default type for destination files and each created directory.
10326 @node rm invocation
10327 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
10330 @cindex removing files or directories
10332 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
10333 directories. Synopsis:
10336 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
10339 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
10340 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
10341 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
10342 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
10343 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
10344 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
10346 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
10347 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
10348 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
10349 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
10350 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
10352 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
10353 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting, as mandated
10356 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
10357 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
10358 that the contents are unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
10360 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10368 @cindex directories, removing
10369 Remove the listed directories if they are empty.
10375 Ignore nonexistent files and missing operands, and never prompt the user.
10376 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
10380 Prompt whether to remove each file.
10381 If the response is not affirmative, silently skip the file without failing.
10382 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
10383 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
10387 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
10388 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
10389 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
10390 @option{--interactive=once}.
10392 @item --interactive [=@var{when}]
10393 @opindex --interactive
10394 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
10395 omitted, or one of:
10398 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
10399 - Do not prompt at all.
10401 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
10402 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
10403 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
10405 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
10406 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
10408 @option{--interactive} with no @var{when} is equivalent to
10409 @option{--interactive=always}.
10411 @item --one-file-system
10412 @opindex --one-file-system
10413 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
10414 When removing a hierarchy recursively, do not remove any directory that is on a
10415 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
10417 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
10418 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
10419 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
10420 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
10421 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
10422 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
10423 under @file{/home}, too.
10424 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
10425 diagnose and skip directories on other file systems.
10426 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
10427 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
10428 See also @option{--preserve-root=all} to protect command line arguments
10431 @item --preserve-root [=all]
10432 @opindex --preserve-root
10433 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
10434 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
10435 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
10436 This is the default behavior.
10437 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10438 When @samp{all} is specified, reject any command line argument
10439 that is not on the same file system as its parent.
10441 @item --no-preserve-root
10442 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10443 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
10444 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
10445 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
10446 remove all the files on your computer.
10447 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10454 @opindex --recursive
10455 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
10456 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
10462 Print the name of each file before removing it.
10466 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
10467 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
10468 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
10469 @samp{-}. GNU @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
10470 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
10471 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
10472 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
10485 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
10486 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
10487 predates the development of the @code{getopt} standard syntax.
10492 @node shred invocation
10493 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
10496 @cindex data, erasing
10497 @cindex erasing data
10499 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
10500 extensive forensics from recovering the data.
10502 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), its data
10503 and metadata are not actually destroyed. Only the file's directory
10504 entry is removed, and the file's storage is reclaimed only when no
10505 process has the file open and no other directory entry links to the
10506 file. And even if file's data and metadata's storage space is freed
10507 for further reuse, there are undelete utilities that will attempt to
10508 reconstruct the file from the data in freed storage, and that can
10509 bring the file back if the storage was not rewritten.
10511 On a busy system with a nearly-full device, space can get reused in a few
10512 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. And although the
10513 undelete utilities and already-existing processes require insider or
10514 superuser access, you may be wary of the superuser,
10515 of processes running on your behalf, or of attackers
10516 that can physically access the storage device. So if you have sensitive
10517 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible
10518 by plausible attacks like these.
10520 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
10521 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
10522 this is often the preferred method. However, some storage devices
10523 are expensive or are harder to destroy, so the @command{shred} utility tries
10524 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively, by overwriting the file
10525 with non-sensitive data.
10527 The @command{shred} command relies on a @strong{crucial assumption}:
10528 that the file system and hardware overwrite data in place.
10529 Although this is common and is the traditional
10530 way to do things, many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
10531 assumption. Exceptions include:
10536 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as ext3/ext4 (in
10537 @code{data=journal} mode), Btrfs, NTFS, ReiserFS, XFS, ZFS, file
10538 systems supplied with AIX and Solaris, etc., when they are configured to
10542 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
10543 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
10546 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
10549 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
10553 Compressed file systems.
10556 For ext3 and ext4 file systems, @command{shred} is less effective
10557 when the file system is in @code{data=journal}
10558 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
10559 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
10560 @command{shred} works as usual. The ext3/ext4 journaling modes can be changed
10561 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
10562 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
10563 the @command{mount} man page (@samp{man mount}). Alternatively, if
10564 you know how large the journal is, you can shred the journal by
10565 shredding enough file data so that the journal cycles around and fills
10566 up with shredded data.
10568 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
10569 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means @command{shred} cannot
10570 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
10572 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
10573 since this bypasses file system design issues mentioned above.
10574 However, devices are also problematic for shredding, for reasons
10575 such as the following:
10580 Solid-state storage devices (SSDs) typically do wear leveling to
10581 prolong service life, and this means writes are distributed to other
10582 blocks by the hardware, so ``overwritten'' data blocks are still
10583 present in the underlying device.
10586 Most storage devices map out bad blocks invisibly to
10587 the application; if the bad blocks contain sensitive data,
10588 @command{shred} won't be able to destroy it.
10591 With some obsolete storage technologies,
10592 it may be possible to take (say) a floppy disk back
10593 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
10594 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
10595 overwritten data. With these older technologies, if the file has been
10596 overwritten only once, it's reputedly not even that hard. Luckily,
10597 this kind of data recovery has become difficult, and there is no
10598 public evidence that today's higher-density storage devices can be
10599 analyzed in this way.
10601 The @command{shred} command can use many overwrite passes,
10602 with data patterns chosen to
10603 maximize the damage they do to the old data.
10604 By default the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives using
10605 now-obsolete technology; for newer devices, a single pass should suffice.
10606 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
10607 @uref{https://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
10608 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
10609 from the proceedings of the Sixth USENIX Security Symposium (San Jose,
10610 California, July 22--25, 1996).
10613 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report these problems, just as
10614 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
10615 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
10616 not deallocate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
10617 for devices, which typically cannot be deallocated and should not be
10620 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
10621 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
10622 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
10623 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
10624 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
10627 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
10630 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10638 @cindex force deletion
10639 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
10641 @item -n @var{number}
10642 @itemx --iterations=@var{number}
10643 @opindex -n @var{number}
10644 @opindex --iterations=@var{number}
10645 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
10646 By default, @command{shred} uses @value{SHRED_DEFAULT_PASSES} passes of
10647 overwrite. You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you think it's
10648 appropriate. After 25 passes all of the internal overwrite patterns will have
10649 been used at least once.
10651 @item --random-source=@var{file}
10652 @opindex --random-source
10653 @cindex random source for shredding
10654 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
10655 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
10657 @item -s @var{bytes}
10658 @itemx --size=@var{bytes}
10659 @opindex -s @var{bytes}
10660 @opindex --size=@var{bytes}
10661 @cindex size of file to shred
10662 Shred the first @var{bytes} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
10663 the whole file. @var{bytes} can be followed by a size specification like
10664 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
10667 @itemx --remove[=@var{how}]
10670 @opindex --remove=unlink
10671 @opindex --remove=wipe
10672 @opindex --remove=wipesync
10673 @cindex removing files after shredding
10674 After shredding a file, deallocate it (if possible) and then remove it.
10675 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
10676 Often the file name is less sensitive than the file data, in which case
10677 the optional @var{how} parameter, supported with the long form option,
10678 gives control of how to more efficiently remove each directory entry.
10679 The @samp{unlink} parameter will just use a standard unlink call,
10680 @samp{wipe} will also first obfuscate bytes in the name, and
10681 @samp{wipesync} will also sync each obfuscated byte in the name to
10683 Although @samp{wipesync} is the default method, it can be expensive,
10684 requiring a sync for every character in every file. This can become
10685 significant with many files, or is redundant if your file system provides
10686 synchronous metadata updates.
10692 Display to standard error all status updates as sterilization proceeds.
10698 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
10699 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the slack space in
10700 the last block of the file. This space may contain portions of the current
10701 system memory on some systems for example.
10702 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
10703 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
10704 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
10705 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
10711 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
10712 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your storage device (for
10713 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
10714 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
10715 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
10716 by the @option{--iterations} option.
10720 You might use the following command to erase the file system you
10721 created on a USB flash drive. This command typically takes several
10722 minutes, depending on the drive's size and write speed. On modern
10723 storage devices a single pass should be adequate, and will take one
10724 third the time of the default three-pass approach.
10727 shred -v -n 1 /dev/sdd1
10730 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
10731 your device, you could give a command like the following.
10734 # 1 pass, write pseudo-random data; 3x faster than the default
10735 shred -v -n1 /dev/sda5
10738 To be on the safe side, use at least one pass that overwrites using
10739 pseudo-random data. I.e., don't be tempted to use @samp{-n0 --zero},
10740 in case some device controller optimizes the process of writing blocks
10741 of all zeros, and thereby does not clear all bytes in a block.
10742 Some SSDs may do just that.
10744 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
10745 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
10752 echo "Hello, world" >&3
10757 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
10758 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
10759 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
10760 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
10765 @node Special file types
10766 @chapter Special file types
10768 @cindex special file types
10769 @cindex file types, special
10771 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
10772 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
10774 @cindex special file types
10776 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
10777 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
10778 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
10779 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
10780 which it does in a @dfn{directory} -- a special type of file. Although
10781 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
10782 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
10783 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
10785 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
10786 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
10789 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
10790 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
10791 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
10792 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
10793 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
10794 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name.
10795 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
10796 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
10800 @node link invocation
10801 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
10804 @cindex links, creating
10805 @cindex hard links, creating
10806 @cindex creating links (hard only)
10808 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
10809 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
10810 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
10811 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10812 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
10813 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
10817 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
10820 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
10821 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
10822 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
10823 to create the link.
10825 On a GNU system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
10826 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
10827 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
10828 not specified by POSIX, and the @command{link} command is
10829 more portable in practice.
10831 If @var{filename} is a symbolic link, it is unspecified whether
10832 @var{linkname} will be a hard link to the symbolic link or to the
10833 target of the symbolic link. Use @command{ln -P} or @command{ln -L}
10834 to specify which behavior is desired.
10839 @node ln invocation
10840 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
10843 @cindex links, creating
10844 @cindex hard links, creating
10845 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
10846 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
10848 @cindex file systems and hard links
10849 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
10850 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
10854 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
10855 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
10856 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
10857 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
10863 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
10864 file from the second.
10867 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
10868 in the current directory.
10871 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
10872 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
10873 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
10874 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
10875 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
10879 Normally @command{ln} does not replace existing files. Use the
10880 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to replace them unconditionally,
10881 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to replace them
10882 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
10883 rename them. Unless the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option is
10884 used there is no brief moment when the destination does not exist;
10885 this is an extension to POSIX.
10887 @cindex hard link, defined
10888 @cindex inode, and hard links
10889 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
10890 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
10891 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
10892 file -- indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
10893 file. Most systems prohibit making a hard link to
10894 a directory; on those where it is allowed, only the super-user can do
10895 so (and with caution, since creating a cycle will cause problems to many
10896 other utilities). Hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
10897 restrictions are not mandated by POSIX, however.)
10899 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
10900 @cindex symbolic link, defined
10901 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
10902 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
10903 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
10904 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
10905 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
10906 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
10907 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
10908 link file itself, rather than on its target. The owner and group of a
10909 symlink are not significant to file access performed through
10910 the link, but do have implications on deleting a symbolic link from a
10911 directory with the restricted deletion bit set. On the GNU system,
10912 the mode of a symlink has no significance and cannot be changed, but
10913 on some BSD systems, the mode can be changed and will affect whether
10914 the symlink will be traversed in file name resolution. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
10915 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10917 Symbolic links can contain arbitrary strings; a @dfn{dangling symlink}
10918 occurs when the string in the symlink does not resolve to a file.
10919 There are no restrictions against creating dangling symbolic links.
10920 There are trade-offs to using absolute or relative symlinks. An
10921 absolute symlink always points to the same file, even if the directory
10922 containing the link is moved. However, if the symlink is visible from
10923 more than one machine (such as on a networked file system), the file
10924 pointed to might not always be the same. A relative symbolic link is
10925 resolved in relation to the directory that contains the link, and is
10926 often useful in referring to files on the same device without regards
10927 to what name that device is mounted on when accessed via networked
10930 When creating a relative symlink in a different location than the
10931 current directory, the resolution of the symlink will be different
10932 than the resolution of the same string from the current directory.
10933 Therefore, many users prefer to first change directories to the
10934 location where the relative symlink will be created, so that
10935 tab-completion or other file resolution will find the same target as
10936 what will be placed in the symlink.
10938 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10949 @opindex --directory
10950 @cindex hard links to directories
10951 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
10953 However, this will probably fail due to
10954 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
10960 Remove existing destination files.
10963 @itemx --interactive
10965 @opindex --interactive
10966 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
10967 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files,
10968 and fail if the response is not affirmative.
10974 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
10975 link, create the hard link to the file referred to by the symbolic
10976 link, rather than the symbolic link itself.
10979 @itemx --no-dereference
10981 @opindex --no-dereference
10982 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
10983 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
10985 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
10986 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
10987 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
10988 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
10989 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
10990 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
10991 non-directory -- as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
10992 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
10993 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
10994 just like a directory.
10996 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
10997 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
11002 @opindex --physical
11003 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
11004 link, create the hard link to the symbolic link itself. On platforms
11005 where this is not supported by the kernel, this option creates a
11006 symbolic link with identical contents; since symbolic link contents
11007 cannot be edited, any file name resolution performed through either
11008 link will be the same as if a hard link had been created.
11013 @opindex --relative
11014 Make symbolic links relative to the link location.
11015 This option is only valid with the @option{--symbolic} option.
11020 ln -srv /a/file /tmp
11021 '/tmp/file' -> '../a/file'
11024 Relative symbolic links are generated based on their canonicalized
11025 containing directory, and canonicalized targets. I.e., all symbolic
11026 links in these file names will be resolved.
11027 @xref{realpath invocation}, which gives greater control
11028 over relative file name generation, as demonstrated in the following example:
11033 test "$1" = --no-symlinks && { nosym=$1; shift; }
11035 test -d "$2" && link="$2/." || link="$2"
11036 rtarget="$(realpath $nosym -m "$target" \
11037 --relative-to "$(dirname "$link")")"
11038 ln -s -v "$rtarget" "$link"
11046 @opindex --symbolic
11047 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
11048 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
11052 @optTargetDirectory
11054 @optNoTargetDirectory
11060 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
11064 @cindex hard links to symbolic links
11065 @cindex symbolic links and @command{ln}
11066 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
11067 precedence. If @option{-s} is also given, @option{-L} and @option{-P}
11068 are silently ignored. If neither option is given, then this
11069 implementation defaults to @option{-P} if the system @code{link} supports
11070 hard links to symbolic links (such as the GNU system), and @option{-L}
11071 if @code{link} follows symbolic links (such as on BSD).
11080 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
11081 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
11086 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
11092 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
11093 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
11097 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
11098 # work across networked file systems.
11099 ln -s afile anotherfile
11100 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
11104 @node mkdir invocation
11105 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
11108 @cindex directories, creating
11109 @cindex creating directories
11111 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
11114 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
11117 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
11118 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
11119 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
11121 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11125 @item -m @var{mode}
11126 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
11129 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
11130 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
11131 which uses the same syntax as
11132 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
11133 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
11134 This option affects only directories given on the command line;
11135 it does not affect any parents that may be created via the @option{-p} option.
11137 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
11138 is created. As a GNU extension, @var{mode} may also mention
11139 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
11140 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
11141 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
11142 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
11143 overridden in this way.
11149 @cindex parent directories, creating
11150 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
11151 file permission bits to @samp{=rwx,u+wx},
11152 that is, with the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
11153 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
11156 If the @option{-m} option is also given, it does not affect
11157 file permission bits of any newly-created parent directories.
11158 To control these bits, set the
11159 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
11160 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
11161 @file{P} it sets the parent's file permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
11162 (The umask must include @samp{u=wx} for this method to work.)
11163 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
11164 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
11165 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
11166 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
11172 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
11173 @option{--parents}.
11182 @node mkfifo invocation
11183 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
11186 @cindex FIFOs, creating
11187 @cindex named pipes, creating
11188 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
11190 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
11191 specified names. Synopsis:
11194 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
11197 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
11198 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
11199 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
11200 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
11202 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11206 @item -m @var{mode}
11207 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
11210 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
11211 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
11212 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
11213 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
11214 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
11223 @node mknod invocation
11224 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
11227 @cindex block special files, creating
11228 @cindex character special files, creating
11230 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
11231 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
11234 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
11237 @cindex special files
11238 @cindex block special files
11239 @cindex character special files
11240 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
11241 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
11242 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
11243 e.g., a printer or a flash drive. (These files are typically created at
11244 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
11245 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
11246 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
11247 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
11249 @c mknod is a shell built-in at least with OpenBSD's /bin/sh
11250 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{mknod}
11252 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
11257 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
11261 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
11262 for a block special file
11265 @c Don't document the 'u' option -- it's just a synonym for 'c'.
11266 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
11268 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
11269 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
11270 for a character special file
11274 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
11275 device numbers must be given after the file type.
11276 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
11277 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
11278 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
11280 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11284 @item -m @var{mode}
11285 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
11288 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
11289 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
11290 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
11291 @xref{File permissions}.
11300 @node readlink invocation
11301 @section @command{readlink}: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
11304 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
11305 @cindex canonical file name
11306 @cindex canonicalize a file name
11309 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
11313 @item Readlink mode
11315 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic links.
11316 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
11317 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
11319 @item Canonicalize mode
11321 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given files which contain
11322 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
11323 (@file{/}) or symbolic links. The @command{realpath} command is the
11324 preferred command to use for canonicalization. @xref{realpath invocation}.
11329 readlink [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
11332 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
11334 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11339 @itemx --canonicalize
11341 @opindex --canonicalize
11342 Activate canonicalize mode.
11343 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
11344 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit
11345 code. A trailing slash is ignored.
11348 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
11350 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
11351 Activate canonicalize mode.
11352 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
11353 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code. A trailing slash
11354 requires that the name resolve to a directory.
11357 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
11359 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
11360 Activate canonicalize mode.
11361 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
11365 @itemx --no-newline
11367 @opindex --no-newline
11368 Do not print the output delimiter, when a single @var{file} is specified.
11369 Print a warning if specified along with multiple @var{file}s.
11379 Suppress most error messages. On by default.
11385 Report error messages.
11391 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
11393 The @command{realpath} command without options, operates like
11394 @command{readlink} in canonicalize mode.
11399 @node rmdir invocation
11400 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
11403 @cindex removing empty directories
11404 @cindex directories, removing empty
11406 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
11409 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
11412 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
11413 directory, it is an error.
11415 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11419 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
11420 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
11421 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
11422 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is non-empty.
11428 @cindex parent directories, removing
11429 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
11430 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
11431 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
11432 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
11433 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
11434 exit unsuccessfully.
11440 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
11441 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
11442 @var{directory} is removed.
11446 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories recursively.
11448 To remove all empty directories under @var{dirname}, including
11449 directories that become empty because other directories are removed,
11450 you can use either of the following commands:
11453 # This uses GNU extensions.
11454 find @var{dirname} -type d -empty -delete
11456 # This runs on any POSIX platform.
11457 find @var{dirname} -depth -type d -exec rmdir @{@} +
11463 @node unlink invocation
11464 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
11467 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
11469 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
11470 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
11471 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
11472 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
11473 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
11474 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
11477 unlink @var{filename}
11480 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
11481 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
11482 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
11484 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
11485 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
11486 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
11491 @node Changing file attributes
11492 @chapter Changing file attributes
11494 @cindex changing file attributes
11495 @cindex file attributes, changing
11496 @cindex attributes, file
11498 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
11499 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
11500 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
11501 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
11502 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
11505 These commands change file attributes.
11508 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
11509 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
11510 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
11511 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
11515 @node chown invocation
11516 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
11519 @cindex file ownership, changing
11520 @cindex group ownership, changing
11521 @cindex changing file ownership
11522 @cindex changing group ownership
11524 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
11525 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
11529 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
11533 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
11534 (with no embedded white space):
11537 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
11544 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
11545 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
11548 @item owner@samp{:}group
11549 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
11550 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
11551 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
11553 @item owner@samp{:}
11554 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
11555 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
11556 @var{owner}'s login group.
11558 @item @samp{:}group
11559 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
11560 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
11561 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
11564 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
11565 owner nor the group is changed.
11569 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
11570 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
11571 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
11573 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
11574 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
11575 require support for that, but for backward compatibility GNU
11576 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results,
11577 although it issues a warning and support may be removed in future versions.
11578 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
11579 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
11580 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
11583 @macro chownGroupRestrictions
11584 It is system dependent whether a user can change the group to an arbitrary one,
11585 or the more portable behavior of being restricted to setting a group of
11586 which the user is a member.
11588 @chownGroupRestrictions
11590 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
11591 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
11592 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
11593 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
11594 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
11595 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
11596 privileges, or when the
11597 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
11598 mandatory locking).
11599 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
11601 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11609 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
11610 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
11619 @cindex error messages, omitting
11620 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
11623 @macro chownFromOption{cmd}
11624 @item --from=@var{old-owner}
11626 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11627 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
11628 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
11630 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
11631 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
11632 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
11633 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
11636 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 \cmd\ -h NEWUSER
11639 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
11640 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{\cmd\} is actually run
11641 may be quite large.
11642 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke \cmd\ for each file
11646 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec \cmd\ -h NEWUSER @{@} \\;
11649 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
11650 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
11651 though still not perfect:
11654 \cmd\ -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
11657 @chownFromOption{chown}
11659 @item --dereference
11660 @opindex --dereference
11661 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11663 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
11664 This is the default when not operating recursively.
11665 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11668 @itemx --no-dereference
11670 @opindex --no-dereference
11671 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11673 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
11674 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
11675 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
11676 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
11677 is a symbolic link.
11678 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
11679 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
11681 @item --preserve-root
11682 @opindex --preserve-root
11683 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
11684 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
11685 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
11686 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11688 @item --no-preserve-root
11689 @opindex --no-preserve-root
11690 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
11691 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
11692 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11694 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
11695 @opindex --reference
11696 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
11697 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
11698 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
11705 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
11706 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
11707 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
11708 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
11709 its referent is being changed.
11714 @opindex --recursive
11715 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
11716 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
11719 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11722 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11723 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11726 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11735 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
11738 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
11739 chown root:staff /u
11741 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
11746 @node chgrp invocation
11747 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
11750 @cindex group ownership, changing
11751 @cindex changing group ownership
11753 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
11754 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
11755 or to the group of an existing reference file. @xref{chown invocation}.
11759 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
11763 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
11764 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
11765 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
11767 @chownGroupRestrictions
11769 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11777 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
11778 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
11787 @cindex error messages, omitting
11788 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
11791 @chownFromOption{chgrp}
11793 @item --dereference
11794 @opindex --dereference
11795 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11797 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
11798 This is the default when not operating recursively.
11799 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11802 @itemx --no-dereference
11804 @opindex --no-dereference
11805 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
11807 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
11808 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
11809 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
11810 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
11811 is a symbolic link.
11812 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
11813 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
11815 @item --preserve-root
11816 @opindex --preserve-root
11817 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
11818 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
11819 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
11820 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11822 @item --no-preserve-root
11823 @opindex --no-preserve-root
11824 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
11825 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
11826 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11828 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
11829 @opindex --reference
11830 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
11831 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
11832 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
11838 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
11839 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
11840 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
11841 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
11842 its referent is being changed.
11847 @opindex --recursive
11848 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
11849 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
11852 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11855 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11856 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11859 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11868 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
11871 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
11876 @node chmod invocation
11877 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
11880 @cindex changing access permissions
11881 @cindex access permissions, changing
11882 @cindex permissions, changing access
11884 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
11887 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
11891 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
11892 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
11893 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
11894 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
11895 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
11896 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
11897 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
11898 recursive directory traversals.
11900 Only a process whose effective user ID matches the user ID of the file,
11901 or a process with appropriate privileges, is permitted to change the
11902 file mode bits of a file.
11904 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
11905 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
11906 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
11907 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
11908 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
11909 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
11910 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
11911 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
11913 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
11914 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
11915 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
11916 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
11917 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
11918 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
11919 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
11921 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11929 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
11938 @cindex error messages, omitting
11939 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
11942 @item --preserve-root
11943 @opindex --preserve-root
11944 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
11945 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
11946 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
11947 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11949 @item --no-preserve-root
11950 @opindex --no-preserve-root
11951 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
11952 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
11953 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11959 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
11961 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
11962 @opindex --reference
11963 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
11964 @xref{File permissions}.
11965 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
11966 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
11971 @opindex --recursive
11972 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
11973 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
11982 # Change file permissions of FOO to be world readable
11983 # and user writable, with no other permissions.
11987 # Add user and group execute permissions to FOO.
11991 # Set file permissions of DIR and subsidiary files to
11992 # be the umask default, assuming execute permissions for
11993 # directories and for files already executable.
11994 chmod -R a=,+rwX dir
11998 @node touch invocation
11999 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
12002 @cindex changing file timestamps
12003 @cindex file timestamps, changing
12004 @cindex timestamps, changing file
12006 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification timestamps of the
12007 specified files. Synopsis:
12010 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
12013 @cindex empty files, creating
12014 Any @var{file} argument that does not exist is created empty, unless
12015 option @option{--no-create} (@option{-c}) or @option{--no-dereference}
12016 (@option{-h}) was in effect.
12018 A @var{file} argument string of @samp{-} is handled specially and
12019 causes @command{touch} to change the times of the file associated with
12022 By default, @command{touch} sets file timestamps to the current time.
12023 Because @command{touch} acts on its operands left to right, the
12024 resulting timestamps of earlier and later operands may disagree.
12026 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
12027 When setting file timestamps to the current time, @command{touch} can
12028 change the timestamps for files that the user does not own but has
12029 write permission for. Otherwise, the user must own the files. Some
12030 older systems have a further restriction: the user must own the files
12031 unless both the access and modification timestamps are being set to the
12034 The @command{touch} command cannot set a file's status change timestamp to
12035 a user-specified value, and cannot change the file's birth time (if
12036 supported) at all. Also, @command{touch} has issues similar to those
12037 affecting all programs that update file timestamps. For example,
12038 @command{touch} may set a file's timestamp to a value that differs
12039 slightly from the requested time. @xref{File timestamps}.
12042 Timestamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
12043 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
12044 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
12045 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
12046 You can avoid ambiguities during
12047 daylight saving transitions by using UTC timestamps.
12049 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12054 @itemx --time=atime
12055 @itemx --time=access
12059 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
12060 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
12061 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
12062 Change the access timestamp only. @xref{File timestamps}.
12067 @opindex --no-create
12068 Do not warn about or create files that do not exist.
12070 @item -d @var{time}
12071 @itemx --date=@var{time}
12075 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
12076 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
12077 example, @option{--date="2020-07-21 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
12078 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
12079 July 21, 2020 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
12080 minutes east of UTC@. @xref{Date input formats}.
12081 File systems that do not support high-resolution timestamps
12082 silently ignore any excess precision here.
12086 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
12087 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
12090 @itemx --no-dereference
12092 @opindex --no-dereference
12093 @cindex symbolic links, changing time
12095 Attempt to change the timestamps of a symbolic link, rather than what
12096 the link refers to. When using this option, empty files are not
12097 created, but option @option{-c} must also be used to avoid warning
12098 about files that do not exist. Not all systems support changing the
12099 timestamps of symlinks, since underlying system support for this
12100 action was not required until POSIX 2008. Also, on some
12101 systems, the mere act of examining a symbolic link changes the access
12102 timestamp, such that only changes to the modification timestamp will persist
12103 long enough to be observable. When coupled with option @option{-r}, a
12104 reference timestamp is taken from a symbolic link rather than the file
12108 @itemx --time=mtime
12109 @itemx --time=modify
12112 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
12113 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
12114 Change the modification timestamp only.
12116 @item -r @var{file}
12117 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
12119 @opindex --reference
12120 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
12121 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
12122 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
12123 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
12124 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a timestamp
12125 equal to five seconds before the corresponding timestamp for @file{foo}.
12126 If @var{file} is a symbolic link, the reference timestamp is taken
12127 from the target of the symlink, unless @option{-h} was also in effect.
12129 @item -t [[@var{cc}]@var{yy}]@var{mmddhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
12130 @cindex leap seconds
12131 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
12132 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
12133 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{cc}
12134 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
12135 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
12136 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
12137 On the atypical systems that support leap seconds, @var{ss} may be
12142 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
12143 On systems predating POSIX 1003.1-2001,
12144 @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
12145 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
12146 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
12147 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{mmddhhmm}[@var{yy}]} and this
12148 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{yy}, if
12149 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
12150 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
12151 for the other files instead of as a file name.
12152 Although this obsolete behavior can be controlled with the
12153 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
12154 conformance}), portable scripts should avoid commands whose
12155 behavior depends on this variable.
12156 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
12157 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
12162 @node File space usage
12163 @chapter File space usage
12165 @cindex File space usage
12168 No file system can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
12169 how much storage is in use or available, report other file and
12170 file status information, and write buffers to file systems.
12173 * df invocation:: Report file system space usage.
12174 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
12175 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
12176 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage.
12177 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file.
12181 @node df invocation
12182 @section @command{df}: Report file system space usage
12185 @cindex file system usage
12186 @cindex disk usage by file system
12188 @command{df} reports the amount of space used and available on
12189 file systems. Synopsis:
12192 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12195 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
12196 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
12197 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
12199 Normally the space is printed in units of
12200 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
12201 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
12203 For bind mounts and without arguments, @command{df} only outputs the statistics
12204 for that device with the shortest mount point name in the list of file systems
12205 (@var{mtab}), i.e., it hides duplicate entries, unless the @option{-a} option is
12208 With the same logic, @command{df} elides a mount entry of a dummy pseudo device
12209 if there is another mount entry of a real block device for that mount point with
12210 the same device number, e.g. the early-boot pseudo file system @samp{rootfs} is
12211 not shown per default when already the real root device has been mounted.
12213 @cindex disk device file
12214 @cindex device file
12215 If an argument @var{file} resolves to a special file containing
12216 a mounted file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that
12217 file system rather than on the file system containing the device node.
12218 GNU @command{df} does not attempt to determine the usage
12219 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
12220 requires extremely non-portable intimate knowledge of file system structures.
12222 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12230 @cindex ignore file systems
12231 Include in the listing dummy, duplicate, or inaccessible file systems, which
12232 are omitted by default. Dummy file systems are typically special purpose
12233 pseudo file systems such as @samp{/proc}, with no associated storage.
12234 Duplicate file systems are local or remote file systems that are mounted
12235 at separate locations in the local file hierarchy, or bind mounted locations.
12236 Inaccessible file systems are those which are mounted but subsequently
12237 over-mounted by another file system at that point, or otherwise inaccessible
12238 due to permissions of the mount point etc.
12240 @item -B @var{size}
12241 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
12243 @opindex --block-size
12244 @cindex file system sizes
12245 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
12246 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
12252 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
12258 @cindex inode usage
12259 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
12260 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
12261 permissions, timestamps, and location on the file system.
12265 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
12266 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
12267 (@pxref{Block size}).
12268 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
12274 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
12275 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
12280 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
12281 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
12282 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
12283 file systems, but on some systems (notably Solaris) the results may be slightly
12284 out of date. This is the default.
12287 @itemx --output[=@var{field_list}]
12289 Use the output format defined by @var{field_list}, or print all fields if
12290 @var{field_list} is omitted. In the latter case, the order of the columns
12291 conforms to the order of the field descriptions below.
12293 The use of the @option{--output} together with each of the options @option{-i},
12294 @option{-P}, and @option{-T} is mutually exclusive.
12296 FIELD_LIST is a comma-separated list of columns to be included in @command{df}'s
12297 output and therefore effectively controls the order of output columns.
12298 Each field can thus be used at the place of choice, but yet must only be
12301 Valid field names in the @var{field_list} are:
12304 The source of the mount point, usually a device.
12309 Total number of inodes.
12311 Number of used inodes.
12313 Number of available inodes.
12315 Percentage of @var{iused} divided by @var{itotal}.
12318 Total number of blocks.
12320 Number of used blocks.
12322 Number of available blocks.
12324 Percentage of @var{used} divided by @var{size}.
12327 The file name if specified on the command line.
12332 The fields for block and inodes statistics are affected by the scaling
12333 options like @option{-h} as usual.
12335 The definition of the @var{field_list} can even be split among several
12336 @option{--output} uses.
12340 # Print the TARGET (i.e., the mount point) along with their percentage
12341 # statistic regarding the blocks and the inodes.
12342 df --out=target --output=pcent,ipcent
12344 # Print all available fields.
12350 @itemx --portability
12352 @opindex --portability
12353 @cindex one-line output format
12354 @cindex POSIX output format
12355 @cindex portable output format
12356 @cindex output format, portable
12357 Use the POSIX output format. This is like the default format except
12362 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
12363 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
12364 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
12365 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
12368 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to POSIX.
12371 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
12372 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
12373 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
12374 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
12375 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
12382 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
12383 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
12384 some systems (notably Solaris), doing this yields more up to date results,
12385 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
12386 there are many or very busy file systems.
12390 @cindex grand total of file system size, usage and available space
12391 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
12392 been processed. This can be used to find out the total size, usage
12393 and available space of all listed devices. If no arguments are specified
12394 df will try harder to elide file systems insignificant to the total
12395 available space, by suppressing duplicate remote file systems.
12397 For the grand total line, @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the
12398 @var{source} column, and @samp{"-"} into the @var{target} column.
12399 If there is no @var{source} column (see @option{--output}), then
12400 @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the @var{target} column,
12403 @item -t @var{fstype}
12404 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
12407 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
12408 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
12409 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
12410 By default, nothing is omitted.
12413 @itemx --print-type
12415 @opindex --print-type
12416 @cindex file system types, printing
12417 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
12418 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
12419 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
12420 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
12425 @cindex NFS file system type
12426 An NFS file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
12427 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
12430 @item ext2@r{, }ext3@r{, }ext4@r{, }xfs@r{, }btrfs@dots{}
12431 @cindex Linux file system types
12432 @cindex local file system types
12433 @opindex ext2 @r{file system type}
12434 @opindex ext3 @r{file system type}
12435 @opindex ext4 @r{file system type}
12436 @opindex xfs @r{file system type}
12437 @opindex btrfs @r{file system type}
12438 A file system on a locally-mounted device. (The system might even
12439 support more than one type here; GNU/Linux does.)
12441 @item iso9660@r{, }cdfs
12442 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
12443 @cindex DVD file system type
12444 @cindex ISO9660 file system type
12445 @opindex iso9660 @r{file system type}
12446 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
12447 A file system on a CD or DVD drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
12448 systems use @samp{iso9660}.
12451 @cindex NTFS file system
12452 @cindex DOS file system
12453 @cindex MS-DOS file system
12454 @cindex MS-Windows file system
12455 @opindex ntfs @r{file system file}
12456 @opindex fat @r{file system file}
12457 File systems used by MS-Windows / MS-DOS.
12461 @item -x @var{fstype}
12462 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
12464 @opindex --exclude-type
12465 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
12466 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
12467 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
12470 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
12474 @command{df} is installed only on systems that have usable mount tables,
12475 so portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
12478 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
12479 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
12480 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
12481 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
12483 Since the list of file systems (@var{mtab}) is needed to determine the
12484 file system type, failure includes the cases when that list cannot
12485 be read and one or more of the options @option{-a}, @option{-l}, @option{-t}
12486 or @option{-x} is used together with a file name argument.
12489 @node du invocation
12490 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
12493 @cindex file space usage
12494 @cindex disk usage for files
12496 @command{du} reports the space needed to represent a set of files.
12500 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12503 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the space needed to represent
12504 the files at or under the current directory.
12505 Normally the space is printed in units of
12506 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
12507 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
12509 If two or more hard links point to the same file, only one of the hard
12510 links is counted. The @var{file} argument order affects which links
12511 are counted, and changing the argument order may change the numbers
12512 and entries that @command{du} outputs.
12514 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12524 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
12526 @item --apparent-size
12527 @opindex --apparent-size
12528 Print apparent sizes, rather than file system usage. The apparent size of a
12529 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
12530 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
12531 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
12532 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
12533 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of file system space, depending on
12534 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
12535 However, a sparse file created with this command:
12538 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
12542 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
12543 file systems, it actually uses almost no space.
12545 Apparent sizes are meaningful only for regular files and symbolic links.
12546 Other file types do not contribute to apparent size.
12548 @item -B @var{size}
12549 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
12551 @opindex --block-size
12553 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
12554 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
12560 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
12566 @cindex grand total of file system space
12567 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
12568 been processed. This can be used to find out the total file system usage of
12569 a given set of files or directories.
12572 @itemx --dereference-args
12574 @opindex --dereference-args
12575 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
12576 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
12577 out the file system usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
12578 are often symbolic links.
12580 @item -d @var{depth}
12581 @itemx --max-depth=@var{depth}
12582 @opindex -d @var{depth}
12583 @opindex --max-depth=@var{depth}
12584 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
12585 Show the total for each directory (and file if @option{--all}) that is at
12586 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
12587 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
12589 @c --files0-from=FILE
12590 @filesZeroFromOption{du,, with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option}
12594 Equivalent to @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
12600 @cindex inode usage, dereferencing in @command{du}
12601 List inode usage information instead of block usage.
12602 This option is useful for finding directories which contain many files, and
12603 therefore eat up most of the inodes space of a file system (see @command{df},
12604 option @option{--inodes}).
12605 It can well be combined with the options @option{-a}, @option{-c},
12606 @option{-h}, @option{-l}, @option{-s}, @option{-S}, @option{-t} and
12607 @option{-x}; however, passing other options regarding the block size, for
12608 example @option{-b}, @option{-m} and @option{--apparent-size}, is ignored.
12612 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
12613 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
12614 (@pxref{Block size}).
12615 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
12618 @itemx --dereference
12620 @opindex --dereference
12621 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
12622 Dereference symbolic links (show the file system space used by the file
12623 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
12627 @itemx --count-links
12629 @opindex --count-links
12630 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
12631 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
12636 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
12637 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
12638 (@pxref{Block size}).
12639 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
12642 @itemx --no-dereference
12644 @opindex --no-dereference
12645 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
12646 For each symbolic link encountered by @command{du},
12647 consider the file system space used by the symbolic link itself.
12650 @itemx --separate-dirs
12652 @opindex --separate-dirs
12653 Normally, in the output of @command{du} (when not using @option{--summarize}),
12654 the size listed next to a directory name, @var{d}, represents the sum
12655 of sizes of all entries beneath @var{d} as well as the size of @var{d} itself.
12656 With @option{--separate-dirs}, the size reported for a directory name,
12657 @var{d}, will exclude the size of any subdirectories.
12664 @opindex --summarize
12665 Display only a total for each argument.
12667 @item -t @var{size}
12668 @itemx --threshold=@var{size}
12670 @opindex --threshold
12671 Exclude entries based on a given @var{size}. The @var{size} refers to used
12672 blocks in normal mode (@pxref{Block size}), or inodes count in conjunction
12673 with the @option{--inodes} option.
12675 If @var{size} is positive, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
12676 greater than or equal to that.
12678 If @var{size} is negative, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
12679 smaller than or equal to that.
12681 Although GNU @command{find} can be used to find files of a certain size,
12682 @command{du}'s @option{--threshold} option can be used to also filter
12683 directories based on a given size.
12685 When combined with the @option{--apparent-size} option, the
12686 @option{--threshold} option elides entries based on apparent size.
12687 When combined with the @option{--inodes} option, it elides entries
12688 based on inode counts.
12690 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories with a size
12691 greater than or equal to 200 megabytes:
12694 du --threshold=200MB
12697 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories and
12698 files -- the @option{-a} -- with an apparent size smaller than or
12699 equal to 500 bytes:
12702 du -a -t -500 --apparent-size
12705 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories on the root
12706 file system with more than 20000 inodes used in the directory tree below:
12709 du --inodes -x --threshold=20000 /
12715 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
12716 Show the most recent modification timestamp (mtime) of any file in the
12717 directory, or any of its subdirectories. @xref{File timestamps}.
12720 @itemx --time=status
12723 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
12724 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
12725 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
12726 Show the most recent status change timestamp (ctime) of any file in
12727 the directory, or any of its subdirectories. @xref{File timestamps}.
12730 @itemx --time=access
12732 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
12733 @opindex access timestamp@r{, show the most recent}
12734 Show the most recent access timestamp (atime) of any file in the
12735 directory, or any of its subdirectories. @xref{File timestamps}.
12737 @item --time-style=@var{style}
12738 @opindex --time-style
12740 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
12741 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
12742 be one of the following:
12745 @item +@var{format}
12747 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
12748 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
12749 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
12750 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2020-07-21 23:45:56}. As
12751 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
12752 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
12755 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601-like date, time, and time zone
12756 components with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21
12757 23:45:56.477817180 -0400}. This style is equivalent to
12758 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
12761 List ISO 8601 date and time components with minute precision, e.g.,
12762 @samp{2020-07-21 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
12763 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
12764 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
12767 List ISO 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21}.
12768 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
12772 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
12773 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
12774 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
12775 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
12776 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
12777 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
12778 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
12780 @item -X @var{file}
12781 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{file}
12782 @opindex -X @var{file}
12783 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{file}
12784 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
12785 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{file},
12786 one per line. If @var{file} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
12789 @item --exclude=@var{pattern}
12790 @opindex --exclude=@var{pattern}
12791 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
12792 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{pattern}.
12793 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
12797 @itemx --one-file-system
12799 @opindex --one-file-system
12800 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
12801 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
12802 the argument being processed is on.
12806 Since @command{du} relies on information reported by the operating
12807 system, its output might not reflect the space consumed in the
12808 underlying devices. For example;
12812 Operating systems normally do not report device space consumed by
12813 duplicate or backup blocks, error correction bits, and so forth.
12814 This causes @command{du} to underestimate the device space actually used.
12817 @cindex copy-on-write and @command{du}
12818 In file systems that use copy-on-write, if two distinct files share
12819 space the output of @command{du} typically counts the space that would
12820 be consumed if all files' non-holes were rewritten, not the space
12821 currently consumed.
12824 @cindex compression and @command{du}
12825 In file systems that use compression, the operating system might
12826 report the uncompressed space. (If it does report the compressed space,
12827 that report might change after one merely overwrites existing file data.)
12830 @cindex networked file systems and @command{du}
12831 Networked file systems historically have had difficulty communicating
12832 accurate file system information from server to client.
12836 For these reasons @command{du} might better be thought of as an
12837 estimate of the size of a @command{tar} or other conventional backup
12838 for a set of files, rather than as a measure of space consumed in the
12839 underlying devices.
12844 @node stat invocation
12845 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
12848 @cindex file status
12849 @cindex file system status
12851 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
12854 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12857 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
12858 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
12859 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
12860 also give information about the files the links point to.
12862 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{stat}
12867 @itemx --dereference
12869 @opindex --dereference
12870 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
12871 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
12872 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
12873 by each symbolic link argument.
12874 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
12877 @itemx --file-system
12879 @opindex --file-system
12880 @cindex file systems
12881 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
12882 instead of information about the files themselves.
12883 This option implies the @option{-L} option.
12885 @item --cached=@var{mode}
12886 @opindex --cached=@var{mode}
12887 @cindex attribute caching
12888 Control how attributes are read from the file system;
12889 if supported by the system. This allows one to
12890 control the trade-off between freshness and efficiency
12891 of attribute access, especially useful with remote file systems.
12896 Always read the already cached attributes if available.
12899 Always synchronize with the latest file system attributes.
12900 This also mounts automounted files.
12903 Leave the caching behavior to the underlying file system.
12908 @itemx --format=@var{format}
12910 @opindex --format=@var{format}
12911 @cindex output format
12912 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
12913 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
12914 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
12915 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
12917 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
12922 @item --printf=@var{format}
12923 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
12924 @cindex output format
12925 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
12926 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
12927 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
12928 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
12929 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
12930 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
12932 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
12941 @cindex terse output
12942 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
12944 The output of the following commands are identical and the @option{--format}
12945 also identifies the items printed (in fuller form) in the default format.
12946 The format string would include another @samp{%C} at the end with an
12947 active SELinux security context.
12949 $ stat --format="%n %s %b %f %u %g %D %i %h %t %T %X %Y %Z %W %o" ...
12953 The same illustrating terse output in @option{--file-system} mode:
12955 $ stat -f --format="%n %i %l %t %s %S %b %f %a %c %d" ...
12956 $ stat -f --terse ...
12960 The valid @var{format} directives for files with @option{--format} and
12961 @option{--printf} are:
12964 @item %a -- Permission bits in octal (see @samp{#} and @samp{0} printf flags)
12965 @item %A -- Permission bits in symbolic form (similar to @command{ls -ld})
12966 @item %b -- Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
12967 @item %B -- The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
12968 @item %C -- The SELinux security context of a file, if available
12969 @item %d -- Device number in decimal (st_dev)
12970 @item %D -- Device number in hex (st_dev)
12971 @item %Hd -- Major device number in decimal
12972 @item %Ld -- Minor device number in decimal
12973 @item %f -- Raw mode in hex
12974 @item %F -- File type
12975 @item %g -- Group ID of owner
12976 @item %G -- Group name of owner
12977 @item %h -- Number of hard links
12978 @item %i -- Inode number
12979 @item %m -- Mount point (see selow)
12980 @item %n -- File name
12981 @item %N -- Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link (see below)
12982 @item %o -- Optimal I/O transfer size hint
12983 @item %s -- Total size, in bytes
12984 @item %r -- Device type in decimal (st_rdev)
12985 @item %R -- Device type in hex (st_rdev)
12986 @item %Hr -- Major device type in decimal (see below)
12987 @item %Lr -- Minor device type in decimal (see below)
12988 @item %t -- Major device type in hex (see below)
12989 @item %T -- Minor device type in hex (see below)
12990 @item %u -- User ID of owner
12991 @item %U -- User name of owner
12992 @item %w -- Time of file birth, or @samp{-} if unknown
12993 @item %W -- Time of file birth as seconds since Epoch, or @samp{0}
12994 @item %x -- Time of last access
12995 @item %X -- Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
12996 @item %y -- Time of last data modification
12997 @item %Y -- Time of last data modification as seconds since Epoch
12998 @item %z -- Time of last status change
12999 @item %Z -- Time of last status change as seconds since Epoch
13002 The @samp{%a} format prints the octal mode, and so it is useful
13003 to control the zero padding of the output with the @samp{#} and @samp{0}
13004 printf flags. For example to pad to at least 3 wide while making larger
13005 numbers unambiguously octal, you can use @samp{%#03a}.
13007 The @samp{%N} format can be set with the environment variable
13008 @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. If that environment variable is not set,
13009 the default value is @samp{shell-escape-always}. Valid quoting styles are:
13012 The @samp{r}, @samp{R}, @samp{%t}, and @samp{%T} formats operate on the st_rdev
13013 member of the stat(2) structure, i.e., the represented device rather than
13014 the containing device, and so are only defined for character and block
13015 special files. On some systems or file types, st_rdev may be used to
13016 represent other quantities.
13018 The @samp{%W}, @samp{%X}, @samp{%Y}, and @samp{%Z} formats accept a
13019 precision preceded by a period to specify the number of digits to
13020 print after the decimal point. For example, @samp{%.3X} outputs the
13021 access timestamp to millisecond precision. If a period is given but no
13022 precision, @command{stat} uses 9 digits, so @samp{%.X} is equivalent to
13023 @samp{%.9X}@. When discarding excess precision, timestamps are truncated
13024 toward minus infinity.
13028 $ stat -c '[%015Y]' /usr
13031 $ stat -c '[%15Y]' /usr
13033 $ stat -c '[%-15Y]' /usr
13036 $ stat -c '[%.3Y]' /usr
13038 $ stat -c '[%.Y]' /usr
13039 [1288929712.114951834]
13042 The mount point printed by @samp{%m} is similar to that output
13043 by @command{df}, except that:
13046 stat does not dereference symlinks by default
13047 (unless @option{-L} is specified)
13049 stat does not search for specified device nodes in the
13050 file system list, instead operating on them directly
13053 stat outputs the alias for a bind mounted file, rather than
13054 the initial mount point of its backing device.
13055 One can recursively call stat until there is no change in output,
13056 to get the current base mount point
13059 When listing file system information (@option{--file-system} (@option{-f})),
13060 you must use a different set of @var{format} directives:
13063 @item %a -- Free blocks available to non-super-user
13064 @item %b -- Total data blocks in file system
13065 @item %c -- Total file nodes in file system
13066 @item %d -- Free file nodes in file system
13067 @item %f -- Free blocks in file system
13068 @item %i -- File System ID in hex
13069 @item %l -- Maximum length of file names
13070 @item %n -- File name
13071 @item %s -- Block size (for faster transfers)
13072 @item %S -- Fundamental block size (for block counts)
13073 @item %t -- Type in hex
13074 @item %T -- Type in human readable form
13078 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
13079 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
13080 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
13081 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
13086 @node sync invocation
13087 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
13090 @cindex synchronize file system and memory
13091 @cindex Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
13093 @command{sync} synchronizes in memory files or file systems to persistent
13097 sync [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
13100 @cindex superblock, writing
13101 @cindex inodes, written buffered
13102 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to the storage device.
13104 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
13105 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
13106 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync},
13107 @code{syncfs}, @code{fsync}, and @code{fdatasync} system calls.
13109 @cindex crashes and corruption
13110 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) device
13111 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
13112 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
13113 result. The @command{sync} command instructs the kernel to write
13114 data in memory to persistent storage.
13116 If any argument is specified then only those files will be
13117 synchronized using the fsync(2) syscall by default.
13119 If at least one file is specified, it is possible to change the
13120 synchronization method with the following options. Also see
13121 @ref{Common options}.
13127 Use fdatasync(2) to sync only the data for the file,
13128 and any metadata required to maintain file system consistency.
13131 @itemx --file-system
13132 @opindex --file-system
13133 Synchronize all the I/O waiting for the file systems that contain the file,
13134 using the syscall syncfs(2). You would usually @emph{not} specify
13135 this option if passing a device node like @samp{/dev/sda} for example,
13136 as that would sync the containing file system rather than the referenced one.
13137 Depending on the system, passing individual device nodes or files
13138 may have different sync characteristics than using no arguments.
13139 I.e., arguments passed to fsync(2) may provide greater guarantees through
13140 write barriers, than a global sync(2) used when no arguments are provided.
13146 @node truncate invocation
13147 @section @command{truncate}: Shrink or extend the size of a file
13150 @cindex truncating, file sizes
13152 @command{truncate} shrinks or extends the size of each @var{file} to the
13153 specified size. Synopsis:
13156 truncate @var{option}@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
13159 @cindex files, creating
13160 Any @var{file} that does not exist is created.
13162 @cindex sparse files, creating
13163 @cindex holes, creating files with
13164 If a @var{file} is larger than the specified size, the extra data is lost.
13165 If a @var{file} is shorter, it is extended and the sparse extended part
13166 (or hole) reads as zero bytes.
13168 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13175 @opindex --no-create
13176 Do not create files that do not exist.
13181 @opindex --io-blocks
13182 Treat @var{size} as number of I/O blocks of the @var{file} rather than bytes.
13184 @item -r @var{rfile}
13185 @itemx --reference=@var{rfile}
13187 @opindex --reference
13188 Base the size of each @var{file} on the size of @var{rfile}.
13190 @item -s @var{size}
13191 @itemx --size=@var{size}
13194 Set or adjust the size of each @var{file} according to @var{size}.
13195 @var{size} is in bytes unless @option{--io-blocks} is specified.
13196 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
13198 @var{size} may also be prefixed by one of the following to adjust
13199 the size of each @var{file} based on its current size:
13201 @samp{+} => extend by
13202 @samp{-} => reduce by
13203 @samp{<} => at most
13204 @samp{>} => at least
13205 @samp{/} => round down to multiple of
13206 @samp{%} => round up to multiple of
13214 @node Printing text
13215 @chapter Printing text
13217 @cindex printing text, commands for
13218 @cindex commands for printing text
13220 This section describes commands that display text strings.
13223 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
13224 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
13225 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
13229 @node echo invocation
13230 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
13233 @cindex displaying text
13234 @cindex printing text
13235 @cindex text, displaying
13236 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
13238 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
13239 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
13242 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
13245 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{echo}
13247 Due to historical and backwards compatibility reasons, certain bare option-like
13248 strings cannot be passed to @command{echo} as non-option arguments.
13249 It is therefore not advisable to use @command{echo} for printing unknown or
13250 variable arguments. The @command{printf} command is recommended as a more
13251 portable and flexible replacement for tasks historically performed by
13252 @command{echo}. @xref{printf invocation}.
13254 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13255 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
13256 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
13262 Do not output the trailing newline.
13266 @cindex backslash escapes
13267 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
13276 produce no further output
13292 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
13293 (zero to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
13294 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
13296 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
13297 (one to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
13298 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
13300 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
13301 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
13306 @cindex backslash escapes
13307 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
13308 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
13309 specified, the last one given takes effect.
13313 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
13314 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
13315 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
13316 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
13317 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
13318 plain @samp{hello}. Also backslash escapes are always enabled.
13319 To echo the string @samp{-n}, one of the characters
13320 can be escaped in either octal or hexadecimal representation.
13321 For example, @code{echo -e '\x2dn'}.
13323 POSIX does not require support for any options, and says
13324 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
13325 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is @option{-n}.
13326 Portable programs should use the @command{printf} command instead.
13327 @xref{printf invocation}.
13332 @node printf invocation
13333 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
13336 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
13339 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
13342 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
13343 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
13344 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function.
13345 @xref{Output Conversion Syntax,, @command{printf} format directives,
13346 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for details.
13347 The differences are listed below.
13349 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{printf}
13354 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
13355 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
13359 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
13360 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
13361 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
13365 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
13366 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
13367 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
13370 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
13371 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
13372 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
13373 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
13378 An additional directive @samp{%b}, prints its
13379 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
13380 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
13381 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits. If
13382 @samp{\@var{ooo}} is nine-bit value, ignore the ninth bit.
13383 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
13384 from the converted string.
13388 An additional directive @samp{%q}, prints its argument string
13389 in a format that can be reused as input by most shells.
13390 Non-printable characters are escaped with the POSIX proposed @samp{$''} syntax,
13391 and shell metacharacters are quoted appropriately.
13392 This is an equivalent format to @command{ls --quoting=shell-escape} output.
13395 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
13396 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
13400 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
13401 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
13402 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
13403 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
13404 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
13405 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
13406 @samp{97} on hosts that use the ASCII character set, since
13407 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in ASCII.
13412 A floating point argument is interpreted according to
13413 the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of either the current or the C locale,
13414 and is printed according to the current locale.
13415 For example, in a locale whose decimal point character is a comma,
13416 the command @samp{printf '%g %g' 2,5 2.5} outputs @samp{2,5 2,5}.
13417 @xref{Floating point}.
13421 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
13422 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a byte to print,
13423 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
13424 digits) specifying a character to print.
13425 However, when @samp{\@var{ooo}} specifies a number larger than 255,
13426 @command{printf} ignores the ninth bit.
13427 For example, @samp{printf '\400'} is equivalent to @samp{printf '\0'}.
13432 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
13434 @command{printf} interprets two syntax forms for specifying Unicode
13435 (ISO/IEC 10646) characters.
13436 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode characters, specified as
13437 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
13438 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
13439 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
13440 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale. Unicode characters in the range
13441 U+D800@dots{}U+DFFF cannot be specified by this syntax.
13442 This syntax fully supports the universal character subset
13443 introduced in ISO C 99.
13445 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
13446 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
13447 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
13448 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
13450 Unicode character syntax is useful for writing strings in a locale
13451 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
13454 $ env printf '\u20AC 14.95'
13458 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
13459 (ISO-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
13462 $ env printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
13466 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
13468 In these examples, the @command{printf} command was
13469 invoked via @command{env} to ensure that we run the program found via
13470 your shell's search path, and not a shell alias or a built-in function.
13472 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
13473 values of each character one by one. ASCII characters mixed with \u
13474 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
13475 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
13476 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
13477 this text in a locale-independent way:
13480 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_TW.big5 env printf \
13481 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
13482 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
13483 | sed -e "s|^|env printf '|" -e "s|%|%%|g" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
13487 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
13488 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
13489 Options must precede operands.
13494 @node yes invocation
13495 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
13498 @cindex repeated output of a string
13500 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
13501 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
13502 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
13504 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
13506 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
13507 To output an argument that begins with
13508 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
13509 @xref{Common options}.
13513 @chapter Conditions
13516 @cindex commands for exit status
13517 @cindex exit status commands
13519 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
13520 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
13521 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
13525 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
13526 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
13527 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
13528 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
13532 @node false invocation
13533 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
13536 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
13537 @cindex failure exit status
13538 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
13540 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
13541 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
13542 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
13543 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
13544 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
13545 command, not the one documented here.
13547 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
13549 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
13550 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
13551 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
13553 Unlike all other programs mentioned in this manual, @command{false}
13554 always exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
13555 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
13557 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
13558 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
13562 @node true invocation
13563 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
13566 @cindex do nothing, successfully
13568 @cindex successful exit
13569 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
13571 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
13572 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
13573 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
13574 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
13575 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
13576 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
13577 command, not the one documented here.
13579 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
13581 However, it is possible to cause @command{true}
13582 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
13583 option, and with standard
13584 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
13585 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
13588 $ ./true --version >&-
13589 ./true: write error: Bad file number
13590 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
13591 ./true: write error: No space left on device
13594 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
13595 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
13596 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
13598 @node test invocation
13599 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
13603 @cindex check file types
13604 @cindex compare values
13605 @cindex expression evaluation
13607 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
13608 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
13609 expression must be a separate argument.
13611 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
13612 comparison operators.
13614 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
13615 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
13616 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
13617 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
13618 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
13619 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
13625 test @var{expression}
13627 [ @var{expression} ]
13632 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{test}
13634 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
13635 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
13636 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true
13637 otherwise. The argument
13638 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
13639 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
13640 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
13641 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
13642 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
13644 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
13648 0 if the expression is true,
13649 1 if the expression is false,
13650 2 if an error occurred.
13654 * File type tests:: @code{-[bcdfhLpSt]}
13655 * Access permission tests:: @code{-[gkruwxOG]}
13656 * File characteristic tests:: @code{-e -s -nt -ot -ef}
13657 * String tests:: @code{-z -n = == !=}
13658 * Numeric tests:: @code{-eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge}
13659 * Connectives for test:: @code{! -a -o}
13663 @node File type tests
13664 @subsection File type tests
13666 @cindex file type tests
13668 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
13669 but not all files are the same!)
13673 @item -b @var{file}
13675 @cindex block special check
13676 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
13678 @item -c @var{file}
13680 @cindex character special check
13681 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
13683 @item -d @var{file}
13685 @cindex directory check
13686 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
13688 @item -f @var{file}
13690 @cindex regular file check
13691 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
13693 @item -h @var{file}
13694 @itemx -L @var{file}
13697 @cindex symbolic link check
13698 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
13699 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
13700 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
13702 @item -p @var{file}
13704 @cindex named pipe check
13705 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
13707 @item -S @var{file}
13709 @cindex socket check
13710 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
13714 @cindex terminal check
13715 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
13721 @node Access permission tests
13722 @subsection Access permission tests
13724 @cindex access permission tests
13725 @cindex permission tests
13727 These options test for particular access permissions.
13731 @item -g @var{file}
13733 @cindex set-group-ID check
13734 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
13736 @item -k @var{file}
13738 @cindex sticky bit check
13739 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
13741 @item -r @var{file}
13743 @cindex readable file check
13744 True if @var{file} exists and the user has read access.
13746 @item -u @var{file}
13748 @cindex set-user-ID check
13749 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
13751 @item -w @var{file}
13753 @cindex writable file check
13754 True if @var{file} exists and the user has write access.
13756 @item -x @var{file}
13758 @cindex executable file check
13759 True if @var{file} exists and the user has execute access
13760 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
13762 @item -O @var{file}
13764 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
13765 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
13767 @item -G @var{file}
13769 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
13770 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
13774 @node File characteristic tests
13775 @subsection File characteristic tests
13777 @cindex file characteristic tests
13779 These options test other file characteristics.
13783 @item -e @var{file}
13785 @cindex existence-of-file check
13786 True if @var{file} exists.
13788 @item -s @var{file}
13790 @cindex nonempty file check
13791 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
13793 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
13795 @cindex newer-than file check
13796 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
13797 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
13799 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
13801 @cindex older-than file check
13802 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
13803 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
13805 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
13807 @cindex same file check
13808 @cindex hard link check
13809 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
13810 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
13812 @item -N @var{file}
13814 @cindex mtime-greater-atime file check
13815 True if @var{file} exists and has been modified (mtime) since it was
13822 @subsection String tests
13824 @cindex string tests
13826 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
13827 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
13833 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
13834 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
13838 @item -z @var{string}
13840 @cindex zero-length string check
13841 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
13843 @item -n @var{string}
13844 @itemx @var{string}
13846 @cindex nonzero-length string check
13847 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
13849 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
13851 @cindex equal string check
13852 True if the strings are equal.
13854 @item @var{string1} == @var{string2}
13856 @cindex equal string check
13857 True if the strings are equal (synonym for @samp{=}).
13858 This form is not as portable to other
13859 shells and systems.
13861 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
13863 @cindex not-equal string check
13864 True if the strings are not equal.
13869 @node Numeric tests
13870 @subsection Numeric tests
13872 @cindex numeric tests
13873 @cindex arithmetic tests
13875 Numeric relational operators. The arguments must be entirely numeric
13876 (possibly negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}},
13877 which evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
13881 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
13882 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
13883 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
13884 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
13885 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
13886 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
13893 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
13894 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
13895 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
13902 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
13904 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
13907 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
13911 @node Connectives for test
13912 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
13914 @cindex logical connectives
13915 @cindex connectives, logical
13917 It is better to use shell logical primitives
13918 rather than these logical connectives internal to @command{test},
13919 because an expression may become ambiguous
13920 depending on the expansion of its parameters.
13922 For example, this becomes ambiguous when @samp{$1}
13923 is set to @samp{'!'} and @samp{$2} to the empty string @samp{''}:
13929 and should be written as:
13932 test "$1" && test "$2"
13935 The shell logical primitives also benefit from
13936 short circuit operation, which can be significant
13937 for file attribute tests.
13943 True if @var{expr} is false.
13944 @samp{!} has lower precedence than all parts of @var{expr}.
13945 The @samp{!} should be specified to the left
13946 of a binary expression, I.e., @samp{! 1 -gt 2}
13947 rather than @samp{1 ! -gt 2}.
13949 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
13951 @cindex logical and operator
13952 @cindex and operator
13953 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
13954 @samp{-a} is left associative,
13955 and has a higher precedence than @samp{-o}.
13957 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
13959 @cindex logical or operator
13960 @cindex or operator
13961 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
13962 @samp{-o} is left associative.
13967 @node expr invocation
13968 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
13971 @cindex expression evaluation
13972 @cindex evaluation of expressions
13974 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
13975 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
13977 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
13978 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
13979 @command{expr} converts
13980 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
13981 depending on the operation being applied to it.
13983 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
13984 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
13985 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
13986 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
13987 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
13988 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
13989 work around this is to use the GNU extension @code{+},
13990 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
13991 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
13992 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
13994 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
13995 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
13996 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
13997 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
13998 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
13999 leading spaces as mentioned above.
14001 @cindex parentheses for grouping
14002 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
14003 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
14004 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
14007 Because @command{expr} uses multiple-precision arithmetic, it works
14008 with integers wider than those of machine registers.
14010 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
14011 options}. Options must precede operands.
14013 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
14017 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
14018 1 if the expression is null or 0,
14019 2 if the expression is invalid,
14020 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
14024 * String expressions:: @code{+ : match substr index length}
14025 * Numeric expressions:: @code{+ - * / %}
14026 * Relations for expr:: @code{| & < <= = == != >= >}
14027 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
14031 @node String expressions
14032 @subsection String expressions
14034 @cindex string expressions
14035 @cindex expressions, string
14037 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
14038 have higher precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
14039 the next sections).
14043 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
14044 @cindex pattern matching
14045 @cindex regular expression matching
14046 @cindex matching patterns
14047 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
14048 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
14049 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
14050 then matched against this regular expression.
14052 If @var{regex} does not use @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the @code{:}
14053 expression returns the number of characters matched, or 0 if the match
14056 If @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the @code{:} expression
14057 returns the part of @var{string} that matched the subexpression, or
14058 the null string if the match failed or the subexpression did not
14059 contribute to the match.
14061 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
14062 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
14063 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
14064 expression operators.
14066 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
14067 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
14068 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
14069 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
14070 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
14071 alternatives. These operators are GNU extensions. @xref{Regular Expressions,,
14072 Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}, for details of
14073 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
14075 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
14077 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
14078 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
14080 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
14082 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
14083 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
14084 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
14086 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
14088 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
14089 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
14090 @var{string}, return 0.
14092 @item length @var{string}
14094 Returns the length of @var{string}.
14096 @item + @var{token}
14098 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
14099 or an operator like @code{/}.
14100 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
14101 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
14102 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
14103 This operator is a GNU extension. Portable shell scripts should use
14104 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
14108 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
14109 @code{quote} operator.
14112 @node Numeric expressions
14113 @subsection Numeric expressions
14115 @cindex numeric expressions
14116 @cindex expressions, numeric
14118 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
14119 precedence. These numeric operators have lower precedence than the
14120 string operators described in the previous section, and higher precedence
14121 than the connectives (next section).
14129 @cindex subtraction
14130 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
14131 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
14137 @cindex multiplication
14140 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
14141 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
14146 @node Relations for expr
14147 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
14149 @cindex connectives, logical
14150 @cindex logical connectives
14151 @cindex relations, numeric or string
14153 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
14154 have lower precedence than the string and numeric operators
14155 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
14161 @cindex logical or operator
14162 @cindex or operator
14163 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
14164 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
14165 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
14170 @cindex logical and operator
14171 @cindex and operator
14172 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
14173 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
14176 @item < <= = == != >= >
14183 @cindex comparison operators
14185 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
14186 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
14187 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
14188 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
14189 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
14194 @node Examples of expr
14195 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
14197 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
14198 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
14200 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
14203 foo=$(expr $foo + 1)
14206 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
14207 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
14210 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
14213 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
14221 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
14223 expr index abcdef cz
14226 @error{} expr: syntax error
14227 expr index + index a
14233 @chapter Redirection
14235 @cindex redirection
14236 @cindex commands for redirection
14238 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection} -- ways
14239 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
14240 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
14241 it's described here.
14244 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes.
14248 @node tee invocation
14249 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
14252 @cindex pipe fitting
14253 @cindex destinations, multiple output
14254 @cindex read from standard input and write to standard output and files
14256 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
14257 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
14258 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
14261 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
14264 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
14265 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
14266 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
14268 In previous versions of GNU Coreutils (5.3.0--8.23),
14269 a @var{file} of @samp{-}
14270 caused @command{tee} to send another copy of input to standard output.
14271 However, as the interleaved output was not very useful, @command{tee} now
14272 conforms to POSIX and treats @samp{-} as a file name.
14274 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14281 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
14285 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
14287 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
14288 Ignore interrupt signals.
14291 @itemx --output-error[=@var{mode}]
14293 @opindex --output-error
14294 Adjust the behavior with errors on the outputs.
14295 In summary @option{-p} allows @command{tee} to operate in a more
14296 appropriate manner with pipes, and to continue to process data
14297 to any remaining outputs, if any pipe outputs exit early.
14298 The default operation when @option{--output-error} is @emph{not}
14299 specified is to exit immediately on error writing to a pipe,
14300 and diagnose errors writing to a non-pipe.
14301 The long form @option{--output-error} option supports selection
14302 between the following @var{mode}s:
14306 Warn on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
14307 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
14308 Exit status indicates failure if any output has an error.
14311 This is the default @var{mode} when not specified,
14312 or when the short form @option{-p} is used.
14313 Warn on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
14314 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
14315 Exit immediately if all remaining outputs become broken pipes.
14316 Exit status indicates failure if any non pipe output had an error.
14319 Exit on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
14322 Exit on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
14323 Exit immediately if all remaining outputs become broken pipes.
14328 The @command{tee} command is useful when you happen to be transferring a large
14329 amount of data and also want to summarize that data without reading
14330 it a second time. For example, when you are downloading a DVD image,
14331 you often want to verify its signature or checksum right away.
14332 The inefficient way to do it is simply:
14335 wget https://example.com/some.iso && sha1sum some.iso
14338 One problem with the above is that it makes you wait for the
14339 download to complete before starting the time-consuming SHA1 computation.
14340 Perhaps even more importantly, the above requires reading
14341 the DVD image a second time (the first was from the network).
14343 The efficient way to do it is to interleave the download
14344 and SHA1 computation. Then, you'll get the checksum for
14345 free, because the entire process parallelizes so well:
14348 # slightly contrived, to demonstrate process substitution
14349 wget -O - https://example.com/dvd.iso \
14350 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) > dvd.iso
14353 That makes @command{tee} write not just to the expected output file,
14354 but also to a pipe running @command{sha1sum} and saving the final
14355 checksum in a file named @file{dvd.sha1}.
14357 However, this example relies on a feature of modern shells
14358 called @dfn{process substitution}
14359 (the @samp{>(command)} syntax, above;
14360 @xref{Process Substitution,,Process Substitution, bash,
14361 The Bash Reference Manual}.),
14362 so it works with @command{zsh}, @command{bash}, and @command{ksh},
14363 but not with @command{/bin/sh}. So if you write code like this
14364 in a shell script, start the script with @samp{#!/bin/bash}.
14366 If any of the process substitutions (or piped standard output)
14367 might exit early without consuming all the data, the @option{-p} option
14368 is needed to allow @command{tee} to continue to process the input
14369 to any remaining outputs.
14371 Since the above example writes to one file and one process,
14372 a more conventional and portable use of @command{tee} is even better:
14375 wget -O - https://example.com/dvd.iso \
14376 | tee dvd.iso | sha1sum > dvd.sha1
14379 You can extend this example to make @command{tee} write to two processes,
14380 computing MD5 and SHA1 checksums in parallel. In this case,
14381 process substitution is required:
14384 wget -O - https://example.com/dvd.iso \
14385 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) \
14386 >(md5sum > dvd.md5) \
14390 This technique is also useful when you want to make a @emph{compressed}
14391 copy of the contents of a pipe.
14392 Consider a tool to graphically summarize file system usage data from
14394 For a large hierarchy, @samp{du -ak} can run for a long time,
14395 and can easily produce terabytes of data, so you won't want to
14396 rerun the command unnecessarily. Nor will you want to save
14397 the uncompressed output.
14399 Doing it the inefficient way, you can't even start the GUI
14400 until after you've compressed all of the @command{du} output:
14403 du -ak | gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz
14404 gzip -d /tmp/du.gz | checkspace -a
14407 With @command{tee} and process substitution, you start the GUI
14408 right away and eliminate the decompression completely:
14411 du -ak | tee >(gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz) | checkspace -a
14414 Finally, if you regularly create more than one type of
14415 compressed tarball at once, for example when @code{make dist} creates
14416 both @command{gzip}-compressed and @command{bzip2}-compressed tarballs,
14417 there may be a better way.
14418 Typical @command{automake}-generated @file{Makefile} rules create
14419 the two compressed tar archives with commands in sequence, like this
14420 (slightly simplified):
14423 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
14424 tar chof - "$tardir" | gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz
14425 tar chof - "$tardir" | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
14428 However, if the hierarchy you are archiving and compressing is larger
14429 than a couple megabytes, and especially if you are using a multi-processor
14430 system with plenty of memory, then you can do much better by reading the
14431 directory contents only once and running the compression programs in parallel:
14434 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
14435 tar chof - "$tardir" \
14436 | tee >(gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz) \
14437 | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
14440 If you want to further process the output from process substitutions,
14441 and those processes write atomically (i.e., write less than the system's
14442 PIPE_BUF size at a time), that's possible with a construct like:
14445 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
14446 tar chof - "$tardir" \
14447 | tee >(md5sum --tag) > >(sha256sum --tag) \
14448 | sort | gpg --clearsign > your-pkg-M.N.tar.sig
14454 @node File name manipulation
14455 @chapter File name manipulation
14457 @cindex file name manipulation
14458 @cindex manipulation of file names
14459 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
14461 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
14464 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
14465 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component.
14466 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability.
14467 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory.
14468 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names.
14472 @node basename invocation
14473 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
14476 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
14477 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
14478 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
14479 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
14480 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
14482 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
14483 @var{name}. Synopsis:
14486 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
14487 basename @var{option}@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
14490 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
14491 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Since trailing slashes
14492 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
14493 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
14496 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
14497 @macro basenameAndDirname
14498 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
14499 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
14500 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
14501 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
14503 @basenameAndDirname
14505 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
14506 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, GNU
14507 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
14508 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
14509 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
14511 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14512 Options must precede operands.
14519 @opindex --multiple
14520 Support more than one argument. Treat every argument as a @var{name}.
14521 With this, an optional @var{suffix} must be specified using the
14522 @option{-s} option.
14524 @item -s @var{suffix}
14525 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
14528 Remove a trailing @var{suffix}.
14529 This option implies the @option{-a} option.
14541 basename /usr/bin/sort
14544 basename include/stdio.h .h
14547 basename -s .h include/stdio.h
14549 # Output "stdio" followed by "stdlib"
14550 basename -a -s .h include/stdio.h include/stdlib.h
14554 @node dirname invocation
14555 @section @command{dirname}: Strip last file name component
14558 @cindex directory components, printing
14559 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
14560 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
14562 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component
14563 of each @var{name}. Slashes on either side of the final component are
14564 also removed. If the string contains no slash, @command{dirname}
14565 prints @samp{.} (meaning the current directory). Synopsis:
14568 dirname [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
14571 @var{name} need not be a file name, but if it is, this operation
14572 effectively lists the directory that contains the final component,
14573 including the case when the final component is itself a directory.
14575 @basenameAndDirname
14577 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
14578 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With GNU @command{dirname}, the
14579 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
14580 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
14582 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14595 # Output "/usr/bin".
14596 dirname /usr/bin/sort
14597 dirname /usr/bin//.//
14599 # Output "dir1" followed by "dir2"
14600 dirname dir1/str dir2/str
14607 @node pathchk invocation
14608 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name validity and portability
14611 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
14612 @cindex valid file names, checking for
14613 @cindex portable file names, checking for
14615 @command{pathchk} checks validity and portability of file names. Synopsis:
14618 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
14621 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints an error message if any of
14622 these conditions is true:
14626 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
14627 (execute) permission,
14629 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
14632 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
14633 its file system's maximum.
14636 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long as a file with that
14637 name could be created under the above conditions.
14639 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14640 Options must precede operands.
14646 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
14647 print an error message if any of these conditions is true:
14651 A file name is empty.
14654 A file name contains a character outside the POSIX portable file
14655 name character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{.},
14656 @samp{_}, @samp{-}, and @samp{/}.
14659 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
14660 POSIX minimum limits for portability.
14665 Print an error message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
14666 that begins with @samp{-}.
14668 @item --portability
14669 @opindex --portability
14670 Print an error message if a file name is not portable to all POSIX
14671 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
14675 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
14679 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
14683 @node mktemp invocation
14684 @section @command{mktemp}: Create temporary file or directory
14687 @cindex file names, creating temporary
14688 @cindex directory, creating temporary
14689 @cindex temporary files and directories
14691 @command{mktemp} manages the creation of temporary files and
14692 directories. Synopsis:
14695 mktemp [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{template}]
14698 Safely create a temporary file or directory based on @var{template},
14699 and print its name. If given, @var{template} must include at least
14700 three consecutive @samp{X}s in the last component. If omitted, the template
14701 @samp{tmp.XXXXXXXXXX} is used, and option @option{--tmpdir} is
14702 implied. The final run of @samp{X}s in the @var{template} will be replaced
14703 by alpha-numeric characters; thus, on a case-sensitive file system,
14704 and with a @var{template} including a run of @var{n} instances of @samp{X},
14705 there are @samp{62**@var{n}} potential file names.
14707 Older scripts used to create temporary files by simply joining the
14708 name of the program with the process id (@samp{$$}) as a suffix.
14709 However, that naming scheme is easily predictable, and suffers from a
14710 race condition where the attacker can create an appropriately named
14711 symbolic link, such that when the script then opens a handle to what
14712 it thought was an unused file, it is instead modifying an existing
14713 file. Using the same scheme to create a directory is slightly safer,
14714 since the @command{mkdir} will fail if the target already exists, but
14715 it is still inferior because it allows for denial of service attacks.
14716 Therefore, modern scripts should use the @command{mktemp} command to
14717 guarantee that the generated name will be unpredictable, and that
14718 knowledge of the temporary file name implies that the file was created
14719 by the current script and cannot be modified by other users.
14721 When creating a file, the resulting file has read and write
14722 permissions for the current user, but no permissions for the group or
14723 others; these permissions are reduced if the current umask is more
14726 Here are some examples (although if you try them, you
14727 will most likely get different file names):
14732 Create a temporary file in the current directory.
14739 Create a temporary file with a known suffix.
14741 $ mktemp --suffix=.txt file-XXXX
14743 $ mktemp file-XXXX-XXXX.txt
14748 Create a secure fifo relative to the user's choice of @env{TMPDIR},
14749 but falling back to the current directory rather than @file{/tmp}.
14750 Although @command{mktemp} does not create fifos, it can create a
14751 secure directory in which fifos can live. Exit the shell if the
14752 directory or fifo could not be created.
14754 $ dir=$(mktemp -p "$@{TMPDIR:-.@}" -d dir-XXXX) || exit 1
14756 $ mkfifo "$fifo" || @{ rmdir "$dir"; exit 1; @}
14760 Create and use a temporary file if possible, but ignore failure. The
14761 file will reside in the directory named by @env{TMPDIR}, if specified,
14762 or else in @file{/tmp}.
14764 $ file=$(mktemp -q) && @{
14765 > # Safe to use $file only within this block. Use quotes,
14766 > # since $TMPDIR, and thus $file, may contain whitespace.
14767 > echo ... > "$file"
14773 Act as a semi-random character generator (it is not fully random,
14774 since it is impacted by the contents of the current directory). To
14775 avoid security holes, do not use the resulting names to create a file.
14785 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14792 @opindex --directory
14793 Create a directory rather than a file. The directory will have read,
14794 write, and search permissions for the current user, but no permissions
14795 for the group or others; these permissions are reduced if the current
14796 umask is more restrictive.
14802 Suppress diagnostics about failure to create a file or directory. The
14803 exit status will still reflect whether a file was created.
14809 Generate a temporary name that does not name an existing file, without
14810 changing the file system contents. Using the output of this command
14811 to create a new file is inherently unsafe, as there is a window of
14812 time between generating the name and using it where another process
14813 can create an object by the same name.
14816 @itemx --tmpdir[=@var{dir}]
14819 Treat @var{template} relative to the directory @var{dir}. If
14820 @var{dir} is not specified (only possible with the long option
14821 @option{--tmpdir}) or is the empty string, use the value of
14822 @env{TMPDIR} if available, otherwise use @samp{/tmp}. If this is
14823 specified, @var{template} must not be absolute. However,
14824 @var{template} can still contain slashes, although intermediate
14825 directories must already exist.
14827 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
14829 Append @var{suffix} to the @var{template}. @var{suffix} must not
14830 contain slash. If @option{--suffix} is specified, @var{template} must
14831 end in @samp{X}; if it is not specified, then an appropriate
14832 @option{--suffix} is inferred by finding the last @samp{X} in
14833 @var{template}. This option exists for use with the default
14834 @var{template} and for the creation of a @var{suffix} that starts with
14839 Treat @var{template} as a single file relative to the value of
14840 @env{TMPDIR} if available, or to the directory specified by
14841 @option{-p}, otherwise to @samp{/tmp}. @var{template} must not
14842 contain slashes. This option is deprecated; the use of @option{-p}
14843 without @option{-t} offers better defaults (by favoring the command
14844 line over @env{TMPDIR}) and more flexibility (by allowing intermediate
14849 @cindex exit status of @command{mktemp}
14853 0 if the file was created,
14858 @node realpath invocation
14859 @section @command{realpath}: Print the resolved file name.
14862 @cindex file names, canonicalization
14863 @cindex symlinks, resolution
14864 @cindex canonical file name
14865 @cindex canonicalize a file name
14869 @command{realpath} expands all symbolic links and resolves references to
14870 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and extra @samp{/} characters. By default,
14871 all but the last component of the specified files must exist. Synopsis:
14874 realpath [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
14877 The file name canonicalization functionality overlaps with that of the
14878 @command{readlink} command. This is the preferred command for
14879 canonicalization as it's a more suitable and standard name. In addition
14880 this command supports relative file name processing functionality.
14882 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14887 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
14889 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
14890 Ensure that all components of the specified file names exist.
14891 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{realpath} will output
14892 a diagnostic unless the @option{-q} option is specified, and exit with a
14893 nonzero exit code. A trailing slash requires that the name resolve to a
14897 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
14899 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
14900 If any component of a specified file name is missing or unavailable,
14901 treat it as a directory.
14907 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
14908 but they are resolved after any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
14913 @opindex --physical
14914 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
14915 and they are resolved before any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
14916 This is the default mode of operation.
14922 Suppress diagnostic messages for specified file names.
14924 @item --relative-to=@var{dir}
14925 @opindex --relative-to
14927 Print the resolved file names relative to the specified directory.
14928 This option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e} options
14929 pertaining to file existence.
14931 @item --relative-base=@var{dir}
14932 @opindex --relative-base
14933 Print the resolved file names as relative @emph{if} the files
14934 are descendants of @var{dir}.
14935 Otherwise, print the resolved file names as absolute.
14936 This option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e} options
14937 pertaining to file existence.
14938 For details about combining @option{--relative-to} and @option{--relative-base},
14939 @pxref{Realpath usage examples}.
14943 @itemx --no-symlinks
14946 @opindex --no-symlinks
14947 Do not resolve symbolic links. Only resolve references to
14948 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and remove extra @samp{/} characters.
14949 When combined with the @option{-m} option, realpath operates
14950 only on the file name, and does not touch any actual file.
14956 @cindex exit status of @command{realpath}
14960 0 if all file names were printed without issue.
14965 * Realpath usage examples:: Realpath usage examples.
14969 @node Realpath usage examples
14970 @subsection Realpath usage examples
14972 @opindex --relative-to
14973 @opindex --relative-base
14975 By default, @command{realpath} prints the absolute file name of given files
14976 (symlinks are resolved, @file{words} is resolved to @file{american-english}):
14981 realpath /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
14982 @result{} /usr/bin/sort
14984 @result{} /usr/share/dict/american-english
14985 @result{} /home/user/1.txt
14989 With @option{--relative-to}, file names are printed relative to
14990 the given directory:
14994 realpath --relative-to=/usr/bin \
14995 /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
14997 @result{} ../../tmp/foo
14998 @result{} ../share/dict/american-english
14999 @result{} ../../home/user/1.txt
15003 With @option{--relative-base}, relative file names are printed @emph{if}
15004 the resolved file name is below the given base directory. For files outside the
15005 base directory absolute file names are printed:
15009 realpath --relative-base=/usr \
15010 /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
15013 @result{} share/dict/american-english
15014 @result{} /home/user/1.txt
15018 When both @option{--relative-to=DIR1} and @option{--relative-base=DIR2}
15019 are used, file names are printed relative to @var{dir1} @emph{if} they are
15020 located below @var{dir2}. If the files are not below @var{dir2}, they are
15021 printed as absolute file names:
15025 realpath --relative-to=/usr/bin --relative-base=/usr \
15026 /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
15029 @result{} ../share/dict/american-english
15030 @result{} /home/user/1.txt
15034 When both @option{--relative-to=DIR1} and @option{--relative-base=DIR2}
15035 are used, @var{dir1} @emph{must} be a subdirectory of @var{dir2}. Otherwise,
15036 @command{realpath} prints absolutes file names.
15039 @node Working context
15040 @chapter Working context
15042 @cindex working context
15043 @cindex commands for printing the working context
15045 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
15046 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
15047 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
15050 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
15051 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
15052 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
15053 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
15057 @node pwd invocation
15058 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
15061 @cindex print name of current directory
15062 @cindex current working directory, printing
15063 @cindex working directory, printing
15066 @command{pwd} prints the name of the current directory. Synopsis:
15069 pwd [@var{option}]@dots{}
15072 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15079 If the contents of the environment variable @env{PWD} provide an
15080 absolute name of the current directory with no @samp{.} or @samp{..}
15081 components, but possibly with symbolic links, then output those
15082 contents. Otherwise, fall back to default @option{-P} handling.
15087 @opindex --physical
15088 Print a fully resolved name for the current directory. That is, all
15089 components of the printed name will be actual directory names -- none
15090 will be symbolic links.
15093 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
15094 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
15095 precedence. If neither option is given, then this implementation uses
15096 @option{-P} as the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
15097 environment variable is set.
15099 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{pwd}
15104 @node stty invocation
15105 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
15108 @cindex change or print terminal settings
15109 @cindex terminal settings
15110 @cindex line settings of terminal
15112 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
15116 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
15117 stty [@var{option}]
15120 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
15121 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
15122 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
15123 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
15124 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
15125 @option{--file} option.
15127 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
15128 the terminal line operation, as described below.
15130 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15137 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
15138 be used in combination with any line settings.
15140 @item -F @var{device}
15141 @itemx --file=@var{device}
15144 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
15145 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
15146 because opening a POSIX tty requires use of the
15147 @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to prevent a POSIX tty from blocking
15148 until the carrier detect line is high if
15149 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
15150 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
15156 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
15157 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
15158 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
15159 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
15163 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
15164 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
15165 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
15166 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
15169 Some settings are not available on all POSIX systems, since they use
15170 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with
15171 ``Non-POSIX'' in their description. On non-POSIX
15172 systems, those or other settings also may not
15173 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
15176 @command{stty} is installed only on platforms with the POSIX terminal
15177 interface, so portable scripts should not rely on its existence on
15178 non-POSIX platforms.
15183 * Control:: Control settings
15184 * Input:: Input settings
15185 * Output:: Output settings
15186 * Local:: Local settings
15187 * Combination:: Combination settings
15188 * Characters:: Special characters
15189 * Special:: Special settings
15194 @subsection Control settings
15196 @cindex control settings
15202 @cindex two-way parity
15203 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
15209 @cindex even parity
15210 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
15214 @cindex constant parity
15215 @cindex stick parity
15216 @cindex mark parity
15217 @cindex space parity
15218 Use "stick" (mark/space) parity. If parodd is set, the parity bit is
15219 always 1; if parodd is not set, the parity bit is always zero.
15220 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15227 @cindex character size
15228 @cindex eight-bit characters
15229 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
15234 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
15240 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
15244 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
15248 @cindex modem control
15249 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
15253 @cindex hardware flow control
15254 @cindex flow control, hardware
15255 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
15256 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15260 @cindex hardware flow control
15261 @cindex flow control, hardware
15262 @cindex DTR/DSR flow control
15263 Enable DTR/DSR flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15268 @subsection Input settings
15270 @cindex input settings
15271 These settings control operations on data received from the terminal.
15276 @cindex breaks, ignoring
15277 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
15281 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
15282 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
15286 @cindex parity, ignoring
15287 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
15291 @cindex parity errors, marking
15292 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
15296 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
15300 @cindex eight-bit input
15301 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
15305 @cindex newline, translating to return
15306 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
15310 @cindex return, ignoring
15311 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
15315 @cindex return, translating to newline
15316 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
15320 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
15321 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
15325 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
15326 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
15327 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{Ctrl-S}/@kbd{Ctrl-Q}). May
15334 @cindex software flow control
15335 @cindex flow control, software
15336 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
15337 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
15338 empty again. May be negated.
15342 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
15343 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
15344 negated. There is no @samp{ilcuc} setting, as one would not be able to issue
15345 almost any (lowercase) Unix command, after invoking it.
15349 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
15350 if negated). Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15354 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
15355 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
15356 when the input buffer is full. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15361 @subsection Output settings
15363 @cindex output settings
15364 These settings control operations on data sent to the terminal.
15369 Postprocess output. May be negated.
15373 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
15374 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
15375 negated. (There is no @samp{ouclc}.)
15379 @cindex return, translating to newline
15380 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15384 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
15385 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-POSIX@. May be
15390 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-POSIX@.
15395 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15399 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
15400 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays.
15406 @cindex pad character
15407 Use ASCII DEL characters for fill instead of
15408 ASCII NUL characters. Non-POSIX@.
15414 Newline delay style. Non-POSIX.
15421 Carriage return delay style. Non-POSIX.
15427 @opindex tab@var{n}
15428 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
15433 Backspace delay style. Non-POSIX.
15438 Vertical tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
15443 Form feed delay style. Non-POSIX.
15448 @subsection Local settings
15450 @cindex local settings
15455 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
15456 characters. May be negated.
15460 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
15461 special characters. May be negated.
15465 Enable non-POSIX special characters. May be negated.
15469 Echo input characters. May be negated.
15475 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
15480 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
15481 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
15485 @cindex newline, echoing
15486 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
15490 @cindex flushing, disabling
15491 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
15492 characters. May be negated.
15496 @cindex case translation
15497 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
15498 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
15499 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15503 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
15504 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-POSIX@.
15511 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
15512 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15518 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
15519 @cindex hat notation for control characters
15520 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
15521 of literally. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15527 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
15528 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
15529 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings.
15535 Enable @samp{LINEMODE}, which is used to avoid echoing
15536 each character over high latency links. See also
15537 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc1116/, Internet RFC 1116}.
15544 This setting is currently ignored on GNU/Linux systems.
15551 @subsection Combination settings
15553 @cindex combination settings
15554 Combination settings:
15561 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
15562 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
15566 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
15567 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
15571 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
15572 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
15576 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
15583 @c This is too long to write inline.
15585 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl
15586 icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl -noflsh
15587 -ixoff -iutf8 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel -xcase -olcuc -ocrnl
15588 opost -ofill onlcr -onocr -onlret nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0 ff0
15589 isig -tostop -ofdel -echoprt echoctl echoke -extproc
15593 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
15597 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
15598 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
15599 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
15600 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
15607 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
15608 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -icanon -opost
15609 -isig -iuclc -ixany -imaxbel -xcase min 1 time 0
15613 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
15617 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
15622 @cindex eight-bit characters
15623 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
15624 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
15628 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
15629 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
15633 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15637 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated. If negated, same
15644 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15645 (Used for terminals with uppercase characters only.)
15649 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
15653 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
15658 @subsection Special characters
15660 @cindex special characters
15661 @cindex characters, special
15663 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
15664 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
15665 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
15666 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
15667 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
15668 any other digit to indicate decimal.
15670 @cindex disabling special characters
15671 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
15672 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
15673 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
15674 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
15675 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
15676 special character to @key{U}.)
15682 Send an interrupt signal.
15686 Send a quit signal.
15690 Erase the last character typed.
15694 Erase the current line.
15698 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
15706 Alternate character to end the line. Non-POSIX.
15711 Alternate character to toggle discarding of output. Non-POSIX.
15715 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-POSIX.
15719 Send an info signal. Not currently supported on GNU/Linux. Non-POSIX.
15723 Restart the output after stopping it.
15731 Send a terminal stop signal.
15735 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-POSIX.
15739 Redraw the current line. Non-POSIX.
15743 Erase the last word typed. Non-POSIX.
15747 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
15748 character. Non-POSIX.
15753 @subsection Special settings
15755 @cindex special settings
15760 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
15761 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
15765 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
15766 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
15768 @item ispeed @var{n}
15770 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
15772 @item ospeed @var{n}
15774 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
15778 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows.
15782 @itemx columns @var{n}
15785 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-POSIX.
15789 @cindex nonblocking @command{stty} setting
15790 Apply settings after first waiting for pending output to be transmitted.
15791 This is enabled by default for GNU @command{stty}.
15792 This is treated as an option rather than a line setting,
15793 and will follow the option processing rules described in the summary above.
15794 It is useful to disable this option
15795 in cases where the system may be in a state where serial transmission
15797 For example, if the system has received the @samp{DC3} character
15798 with @code{ixon} (software flow control) enabled, then @command{stty} would
15799 block without @code{-drain} being specified.
15800 May be negated. Non-POSIX.
15806 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
15807 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
15808 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
15809 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
15814 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-POSIX.
15818 Print the terminal speed.
15821 @cindex baud rate, setting
15822 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one of: 0
15823 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600 19200
15824 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as 19200;
15825 @code{extb} is the same as 38400. Many systems, including GNU/Linux,
15826 support higher speeds. The @command{stty} command includes support
15843 4000000 where the system supports these.
15844 0 hangs up the line if @option{-clocal} is set.
15848 @node printenv invocation
15849 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
15852 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
15853 @cindex environment variables, printing
15855 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
15858 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
15861 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
15862 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
15863 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
15865 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15873 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
15877 0 if all variables specified were found
15878 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
15879 2 if a write error occurred
15883 @node tty invocation
15884 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
15887 @cindex print terminal file name
15888 @cindex terminal file name, printing
15890 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
15891 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
15895 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
15898 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15908 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
15912 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
15916 0 if standard input is a terminal
15917 1 if standard input is a non-terminal file
15918 2 if given incorrect arguments
15919 3 if a write error occurs
15923 @node User information
15924 @chapter User information
15926 @cindex user information, commands for
15927 @cindex commands for printing user information
15929 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
15930 logins, groups, and so forth.
15933 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
15934 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
15935 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
15936 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
15937 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
15938 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
15939 * pinky invocation:: Print information about users.
15943 @node id invocation
15944 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
15947 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
15948 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
15949 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
15951 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
15952 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
15955 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user}]@dots{}
15958 @var{user} can be either a user ID or a name, with name look-up
15959 taking precedence unless the ID is specified with a leading @samp{+}.
15960 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
15962 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
15963 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
15964 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
15965 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
15966 In addition, if SELinux
15967 is enabled and the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is not set,
15968 then print @samp{context=@var{c}}, where @var{c} is the security context.
15970 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
15971 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
15973 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
15974 Also see @ref{Common options}.
15981 Print only the group ID.
15987 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
15993 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
15994 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
16000 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID@. Requires
16001 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
16007 Print only the user ID.
16014 @cindex security context
16015 Print only the security context of the process, which is generally
16016 the user's security context inherited from the parent process.
16017 If neither SELinux or SMACK is enabled then print a warning and
16018 set the exit status to 1.
16024 Delimit output items with ASCII NUL characters.
16025 This option is not permitted when using the default format.
16026 When multiple users are specified, and the @option{--groups} option
16027 is also in effect, groups are delimited with a single NUL character,
16028 while users are delimited with two NUL characters.
16033 users <NUL> devs <NUL>
16038 @macro primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{cmd,arg}
16039 Primary and supplementary groups for a process are normally inherited
16040 from its parent and are usually unchanged since login. This means
16041 that if you change the group database after logging in, @command{\cmd\}
16042 will not reflect your changes within your existing login session.
16043 Running @command{\cmd\} with a \arg\ causes the user and group
16044 database to be consulted afresh, and so will give a different result.
16046 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{id,user argument}
16050 @node logname invocation
16051 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
16054 @cindex printing user's login name
16055 @cindex login name, printing
16056 @cindex user name, printing
16059 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
16060 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
16061 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
16062 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
16063 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
16065 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16071 @node whoami invocation
16072 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user name
16075 @cindex effective user name, printing
16076 @cindex printing the effective user ID
16078 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
16079 effective user ID@. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
16081 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16087 @node groups invocation
16088 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
16091 @cindex printing groups a user is in
16092 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
16094 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
16095 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
16096 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
16098 the list of that user's groups and the user name is separated from the
16099 group list by a colon. Synopsis:
16102 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
16105 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
16107 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16110 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{groups,list of users}
16114 @node users invocation
16115 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
16118 @cindex printing current usernames
16119 @cindex usernames, printing current
16121 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
16122 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
16123 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
16124 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
16125 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
16134 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
16135 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
16136 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
16137 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
16139 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16142 The @command{users} command is installed only on platforms with the
16143 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
16144 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
16149 @node who invocation
16150 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
16153 @cindex printing current user information
16154 @cindex information, about current users
16156 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
16160 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
16163 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
16165 @cindex remote hostname
16166 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
16167 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
16168 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
16172 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
16173 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
16174 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
16175 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
16176 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
16180 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
16181 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
16182 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
16183 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
16186 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
16187 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
16188 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
16189 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
16191 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16199 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
16205 Print the date and time of last system boot.
16211 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
16217 Print a line of column headings.
16223 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
16224 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
16228 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
16229 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
16230 automatic dial-up internet access.
16234 Same as @samp{who am i}.
16240 List active processes spawned by init.
16246 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
16247 Overrides all other options.
16252 @opindex --runlevel
16253 Print the current (and maybe previous) run-level of the init process.
16257 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
16263 Print last system clock change.
16268 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
16269 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
16270 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
16281 @opindex --writable
16282 @cindex message status
16283 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
16284 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
16287 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
16288 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
16289 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
16294 The @command{who} command is installed only on platforms with the
16295 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
16296 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
16301 @node pinky invocation
16302 @section @command{pinky}: Print information about users
16304 @command{pinky} is a lightweight implementation of the @command{finger} command.
16308 @command{pinky} [@var{option}] [@var{username}]@dots{}
16311 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16317 Produce long format output.
16319 When producing long output at least one @var{username} must be given.
16320 If @var{username} cannot be found, the real name is printed as
16321 @samp{???} and the home directory and shell are omitted.
16325 Omit the user's home directory and shell when printing in long format.
16329 Omit the user's project file when printing in long format.
16333 Omit the user's plan file when printing in long format.
16337 Produce short format output. This is the default behavior when no
16342 Omit the column headings when printing in short format.
16346 Omit the user's full name when printing in short format.
16350 Omit the user's full name and remote host when printing in short
16355 Omit the user's full name, remote host, and idle time when printing in
16363 @node System context
16364 @chapter System context
16366 @cindex system context
16367 @cindex context, system
16368 @cindex commands for system context
16370 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
16374 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
16375 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name.
16376 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors.
16377 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
16378 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
16379 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
16380 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load.
16383 @node date invocation
16384 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
16387 @cindex time, printing or setting
16388 @cindex printing the current time
16393 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
16394 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
16395 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
16398 The @command{date} command displays the date and time.
16399 With the @option{--set} (@option{-s}) option, or with
16400 @samp{MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss]},
16401 it sets the date and time.
16404 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
16405 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
16406 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
16407 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Jul @ 9 17:00:00 EDT 2020}.
16410 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
16411 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
16412 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
16413 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
16418 * Date format specifiers:: Used in @samp{date '+...'}
16419 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
16420 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
16422 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
16424 * Examples of date:: Examples.
16427 @node Date format specifiers
16428 @subsection Specifying the format of @command{date} output
16430 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
16431 @cindex time formats
16432 @cindex formatting times
16433 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
16434 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
16435 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
16436 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
16437 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
16438 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
16442 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
16443 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
16444 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
16445 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
16448 @node Time conversion specifiers
16449 @subsubsection Time conversion specifiers
16451 @cindex time conversion specifiers
16452 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
16454 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
16458 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
16460 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
16462 hour, space padded (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}); equivalent to @samp{%_H}@.
16463 This is a GNU extension.
16465 hour, space padded (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}); equivalent to @samp{%_I}@.
16466 This is a GNU extension.
16468 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
16470 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
16471 This is a GNU extension.
16473 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
16474 blank in many locales.
16475 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
16477 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
16478 This is a GNU extension.
16480 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
16482 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
16484 @cindex Epoch, seconds since
16485 @cindex seconds since the Epoch
16486 @cindex beginning of time
16487 @cindex leap seconds
16488 seconds since the Epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00 UTC@.
16489 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
16490 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
16491 This is a GNU extension.
16493 @cindex leap seconds
16494 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
16495 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
16497 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
16499 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
16501 Four-digit numeric time zone, e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}, or
16503 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
16504 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
16505 by the @env{TZ} environment variable. A time zone is not determinable if
16506 its numeric offset is zero and its abbreviation begins with @samp{-}.
16507 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
16508 by the @option{--date} option.
16510 Numeric time zone with @samp{:}, e.g., @samp{-06:00} or
16511 @samp{+05:30}), or @samp{-00:00} if no time zone is determinable.
16512 This is a GNU extension.
16514 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
16515 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or @samp{-00:00:00} if no time zone is
16517 This is a GNU extension.
16519 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
16520 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or @samp{-00} if
16521 no time zone is determinable.
16522 This is a GNU extension.
16524 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
16525 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
16529 @node Date conversion specifiers
16530 @subsubsection Date conversion specifiers
16532 @cindex date conversion specifiers
16533 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
16535 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
16539 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
16541 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
16543 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
16545 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
16547 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2020})
16549 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
16550 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2019},
16551 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
16552 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
16554 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
16556 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
16558 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
16560 full date in ISO 8601 format; like @samp{%+4Y-%m-%d}
16561 except that any flags or field width override the @samp{+}
16562 and (after subtracting 6) the @samp{4}.
16563 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
16564 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
16567 year corresponding to the ISO week number, but without the century
16568 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
16569 as @samp{%y}, except that if the ISO week number (see
16571 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
16573 year corresponding to the ISO week number. This has the
16574 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the ISO
16576 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
16578 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
16579 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
16580 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
16584 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
16586 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
16588 quarter of year (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{4})
16590 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
16592 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
16593 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
16594 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
16596 ISO week number, that is, the
16597 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
16598 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
16599 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
16600 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
16601 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the ISO 8601
16604 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
16606 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
16607 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
16608 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
16610 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
16612 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
16614 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
16615 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
16616 precedes year @samp{0000}.
16620 @node Literal conversion specifiers
16621 @subsubsection Literal conversion specifiers
16623 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
16624 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
16626 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
16638 @node Padding and other flags
16639 @subsubsection Padding and other flags
16641 @cindex numeric field padding
16642 @cindex padding of numeric fields
16643 @cindex fields, padding numeric
16645 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
16646 with zeros, so that, for
16647 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
16648 Most numeric fields are padded on the left.
16649 However, nanoseconds are padded on the right since they are commonly
16650 used after decimal points in formats like @samp{%s.%-N}.
16651 Also, seconds since the Epoch are not padded
16652 since there is no natural width for them.
16654 The following optional flags can appear after the @samp{%}:
16658 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
16660 This is a GNU extension.
16661 As a special case, @samp{%-N} outputs only enough trailing digits to
16662 not lose information, assuming that the timestamp's resolution is the
16663 same as the current hardware clock. For example, if the hardware
16664 clock resolution is 1 microsecond, @samp{%s.%-N} outputs something
16665 like @samp{1640890100.395710}.
16668 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
16669 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
16670 This is a GNU extension.
16672 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
16673 would normally pad with spaces.
16675 Pad with zeros, like @samp{0}. In addition, precede any year number
16676 with @samp{+} if it exceeds 9999 or if its field width exceeds 4;
16677 similarly, precede any century number with @samp{+} if it exceeds 99
16678 or if its field width exceeds 2. This supports ISO 8601 formats
16679 for dates far in the future; for example, the command @code{date
16680 --date=12019-02-25 +%+13F} outputs the string @samp{+012019-02-25}.
16682 Use upper case characters if possible.
16683 This is a GNU extension.
16685 Use opposite case characters if possible.
16686 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
16687 This is a GNU extension.
16691 Here are some examples of padding:
16694 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
16696 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
16698 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
16702 You can optionally specify the field width
16703 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
16704 output of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
16705 the result is normally written right adjusted and padded to the given
16706 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
16707 a field of width 9. Nanoseconds are left adjusted, and are truncated
16708 or padded to the field width.
16710 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
16711 specification. The modifiers are:
16715 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
16716 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
16717 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
16718 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
16722 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
16723 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
16726 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
16727 is available, it is ignored.
16729 POSIX specifies the behavior of flags and field widths only for
16730 @samp{%C}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}, and @samp{%Y} (all without
16731 modifiers), and requires a flag to be present if and only if a field
16732 width is also present. Other combinations of flags, field widths and
16733 modifiers are GNU extensions.
16736 @node Setting the time
16737 @subsection Setting the time
16739 @cindex setting the time
16740 @cindex time setting
16741 @cindex appropriate privileges
16743 You must have appropriate privileges to set the
16744 system clock. For changes to persist across a reboot, the
16745 hardware clock may need to be updated from the system clock, which
16746 might not happen automatically on your system.
16748 To set the clock, you can use the @option{--set} (@option{-s}) option
16749 (@pxref{Options for date}). To set the clock without using GNU
16750 extensions, you can give @command{date} an argument of the form
16751 @samp{MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss]} where each two-letter
16752 component stands for two digits with the following meanings:
16764 first two digits of year (optional)
16766 last two digits of year (optional)
16771 The @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be used with an
16772 argument in the above format. The @option{--universal} option may be used
16773 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
16774 relative to Universal Time rather than to the local time zone.
16777 @node Options for date
16778 @subsection Options for @command{date}
16780 @cindex @command{date} options
16781 @cindex options for @command{date}
16783 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16784 Except for @option{-u}, these options are all GNU extensions to POSIX.
16786 All options that specify the date to display are mutually exclusive.
16787 I.e.: @option{--date}, @option{--file}, @option{--reference},
16788 @option{--resolution}.
16792 @item -d @var{datestr}
16793 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
16796 @cindex parsing date strings
16797 @cindex date strings, parsing
16798 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
16801 @opindex next @var{day}
16802 @opindex last @var{day}
16803 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
16804 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
16805 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
16806 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2020-07-21
16807 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
16808 489,392,193 nanoseconds after July 21, 2020 at 2:19:13 PM in a
16809 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of UTC.@*
16810 The @var{datestr} must be in locale independent format. E.g., the
16811 @samp{LC_TIME=C} below is needed to print the correct date in many locales:
16813 date -d "$(LC_TIME=C date)"
16815 @xref{Date input formats}.
16819 @cindex debugging date strings
16820 @cindex date strings, debugging
16821 @cindex arbitrary date strings, debugging
16822 Annotate the parsed date, display the effective time zone, and warn about
16825 @item -f @var{datefile}
16826 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
16829 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
16830 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
16831 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
16832 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
16835 @item -I[@var{timespec}]
16836 @itemx --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
16837 @opindex -I[@var{timespec}]
16838 @opindex --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
16839 Display the date using an ISO 8601 format, @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
16841 The argument @var{timespec} specifies the number of additional
16842 terms of the time to include. It can be one of the following:
16845 Print just the date. This is the default if @var{timespec} is omitted.
16846 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
16849 Also print hours and time zone.
16850 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H%:z}.
16853 Also print minutes.
16854 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H:%M%:z}.
16857 Also print seconds.
16858 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H:%M:%S%:z}.
16861 Also print nanoseconds.
16862 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H:%M:%S,%N%:z}.
16865 @macro dateParseNote
16866 This format is always suitable as input
16867 for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
16868 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
16872 @item -r @var{file}
16873 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
16875 @opindex --reference
16876 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
16877 instead of the current date and time.
16880 @opindex --resolution
16881 Display the timestamp resolution instead of the time.
16882 Current clock timestamps that are output by @command{date}
16883 are integer multiples of the timestamp resolution.
16884 With this option, the format defaults to @samp{%s.%N}.
16885 For example, if the clock resolution is 1 millisecond,
16895 @opindex --rfc-email
16896 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
16897 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
16901 Mon, 09 Jul 2020 17:00:00 -0400
16905 @opindex --rfc-2822
16906 This format conforms to Internet RFCs
16907 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc5322/, 5322},
16908 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc2822/, 2822} and
16909 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc822/, 822}, the
16910 current and previous standards for Internet email.
16911 For compatibility with older versions of @command{date},
16912 @option{--rfc-2822} and @option{--rfc-822} are aliases for
16913 @option{--rfc-email}.
16915 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
16916 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
16917 Display the date using a format specified by
16918 @uref{https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/rfc3339/, Internet
16919 RFC 3339}. This is like @option{--iso-8601}, except that a space rather
16920 than a @samp{T} separates dates from times, and a period rather than
16921 a comma separates seconds from subseconds.
16924 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
16925 It can be one of the following:
16929 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21}.
16930 This is like the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
16933 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
16934 @samp{2020-07-21 04:30:37+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
16935 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
16936 hours and thirty minutes east of UTC@. This is like
16937 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
16940 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
16941 @samp{2020-07-21 04:30:37.998458565+05:30}.
16942 This is like the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
16946 @item -s @var{datestr}
16947 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
16950 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
16951 See also @ref{Setting the time}.
16958 @opindex --universal
16959 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
16961 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
16963 @cindex leap seconds
16965 @cindex Universal Time
16966 Use Universal Time by operating as if the
16967 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
16968 UTC stands for Coordinated Universal Time, established in 1960.
16969 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (GMT) for
16970 historical reasons.
16971 Typically, systems ignore leap seconds and thus implement an
16972 approximation to UTC rather than true UTC.
16976 @node Examples of date
16977 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
16979 @cindex examples of @command{date}
16981 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
16982 option in the previous section.
16987 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
16990 date --date='2 days ago'
16994 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
16997 date --date='3 months 1 day'
17001 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
17004 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
17008 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
17014 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
17015 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
17016 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
17019 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
17020 of the month, you can use the (GNU extension)
17021 @samp{-} flag to suppress
17022 the padding altogether:
17025 date -d 1may '+%B %-d'
17029 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
17030 non-GNU versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
17033 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
17037 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
17040 date --set='+2 minutes'
17044 To print the date in Internet RFC 5322 format,
17045 use @samp{date --rfc-email}. Here is some example output:
17048 Tue, 09 Jul 2020 19:00:37 -0400
17051 @anchor{%s-examples}
17053 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the Epoch
17054 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
17055 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
17056 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
17057 number of the seconds since the Epoch for the time two minutes after the
17061 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
17065 To convert a date string from one time zone @var{from} to another @var{to},
17066 specify @samp{TZ="@var{from}"} in the environment and @samp{TZ="@var{to}"}
17067 in the @option{--date} option. @xref{Specifying time zone rules}.
17071 TZ="Asia/Tokyo" date --date='TZ="America/New_York" 2023-05-07 12:23'
17072 Mon May @ 8 01:23:00 JST 2023
17075 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
17076 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
17077 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
17078 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
17079 seconds) behind UTC:
17082 # local time zone used
17083 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
17088 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
17089 represented as seconds since the Epoch. But few people can look at
17090 the date @samp{1577836800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first
17091 second of the year 2020 in Greenwich, England.''
17094 date --date='2020-01-01 UTC' +%s
17098 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
17099 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
17100 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
17101 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
17102 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
17105 date -u --date=2020-07-21 +%s
17109 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
17110 a more readable form, use a command like this:
17113 date -d @@1595289600 +"%F %T %z"
17114 2020-07-20 20:00:00 -0400
17117 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
17120 date -u -d @@1595289600 +"%F %T %z"
17121 2020-07-21 00:00:00 +0000
17125 @cindex leap seconds
17126 Typically the seconds count omits leap seconds, but some systems are
17127 exceptions. Because leap seconds are not predictable, the mapping
17128 between the seconds count and a future timestamp is not reliable on
17129 the atypical systems that include leap seconds in their counts.
17131 Here is how the two kinds of systems handle the leap second at
17132 the end of the year 2016:
17135 # Typical systems ignore leap seconds:
17136 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
17138 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
17139 date: invalid date '2016-12-31 23:59:60 +0000'
17140 date --date='2017-01-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
17145 # Atypical systems count leap seconds:
17146 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
17148 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
17150 date --date='2017-01-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
17157 @node arch invocation
17158 @section @command{arch}: Print machine hardware name
17161 @cindex print machine hardware name
17162 @cindex system information, printing
17164 @command{arch} prints the machine hardware name,
17165 and is equivalent to @samp{uname -m}.
17169 arch [@var{option}]
17172 The program accepts the @ref{Common options} only.
17174 @command{arch} is not installed by default, so portable scripts should
17175 not rely on its existence.
17180 @node nproc invocation
17181 @section @command{nproc}: Print the number of available processors
17184 @cindex Print the number of processors
17185 @cindex system information, printing
17187 Print the number of processing units available to the current process,
17188 which may be less than the number of online processors.
17189 If this information is not accessible, then print the number of
17190 processors installed. If the @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} or @env{OMP_THREAD_LIMIT}
17191 environment variables are set, then they will determine the minimum
17192 and maximum returned value respectively. The result is guaranteed to be
17193 greater than zero. Synopsis:
17196 nproc [@var{option}]
17199 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17205 Print the number of installed processors on the system, which may
17206 be greater than the number online or available to the current process.
17207 The @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} or @env{OMP_THREAD_LIMIT} environment variables
17208 are not honored in this case.
17210 @item --ignore=@var{number}
17212 If possible, exclude this @var{number} of processing units.
17219 @node uname invocation
17220 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
17223 @cindex print system information
17224 @cindex system information, printing
17226 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
17227 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
17228 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
17231 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
17234 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
17235 printed in this order:
17238 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
17239 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
17242 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
17243 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{kernel-version} is
17244 @samp{#1 SMP Fri Jul 17 17:18:38 UTC 2020}:
17248 @result{} Linux dumdum.example.org 5.9.16-200.fc33.x86_64@c
17249 #1 SMP Mon Dec 21 14:08:22 UTC 2020 x86_64 x86_64 x86_64 GNU/Linux
17253 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17261 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
17262 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
17265 @itemx --hardware-platform
17267 @opindex --hardware-platform
17268 @cindex implementation, hardware
17269 @cindex hardware platform
17270 @cindex platform, hardware
17271 Print the hardware platform name
17272 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
17273 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
17274 This is non-portable, even across GNU/Linux distributions.
17280 @cindex machine type
17281 @cindex hardware class
17282 @cindex hardware type
17283 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
17289 @opindex --nodename
17292 @cindex network node name
17293 Print the network node hostname.
17298 @opindex --processor
17299 @cindex host processor type
17300 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
17301 architecture or ISA).
17302 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
17303 This is non-portable, even across GNU/Linux distributions.
17306 @itemx --operating-system
17308 @opindex --operating-system
17309 @cindex operating system name
17310 Print the name of the operating system.
17313 @itemx --kernel-release
17315 @opindex --kernel-release
17316 @cindex kernel release
17317 @cindex release of kernel
17318 Print the kernel release.
17321 @itemx --kernel-name
17323 @opindex --kernel-name
17324 @cindex kernel name
17325 @cindex name of kernel
17326 Print the kernel name.
17327 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
17328 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
17329 POSIX specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
17330 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
17331 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
17332 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
17333 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
17337 @itemx --kernel-version
17339 @opindex --kernel-version
17340 @cindex kernel version
17341 @cindex version of kernel
17342 Print the kernel version.
17349 @node hostname invocation
17350 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
17353 @cindex setting the hostname
17354 @cindex printing the hostname
17355 @cindex system name, printing
17356 @cindex appropriate privileges
17358 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
17359 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
17360 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
17364 hostname [@var{name}]
17367 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
17370 @command{hostname} is not installed by default, and other packages
17371 also supply a @command{hostname} command, so portable scripts should
17372 not rely on its existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
17377 @node hostid invocation
17378 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier
17381 @cindex printing the host identifier
17383 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
17384 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
17385 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
17386 @xref{Common options}.
17388 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
17395 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
17396 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
17399 @command{hostid} is installed only on systems that have the
17400 @code{gethostid} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
17405 @node uptime invocation
17406 @section @command{uptime}: Print system uptime and load
17409 @cindex printing the system uptime and load
17411 @command{uptime} prints the current time, the system's uptime, the
17412 number of logged-in users and the current load average.
17414 If an argument is specified, it is used as the file to be read
17415 to discover how many users are logged in. If no argument is
17416 specified, a system default is used (@command{uptime --help} indicates
17417 the default setting).
17419 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
17420 @xref{Common options}.
17422 For example, here's what it prints right now on one system I use:
17426 14:07 up 3:35, 3 users, load average: 1.39, 1.15, 1.04
17429 The precise method of calculation of load average varies somewhat
17430 between systems. Some systems calculate it as the average number of
17431 runnable processes over the last 1, 5 and 15 minutes, but some systems
17432 also include processes in the uninterruptible sleep state (that is,
17433 those processes which are waiting for device I/O). The Linux kernel
17434 includes uninterruptible processes.
17436 @command{uptime} is installed only on platforms with infrastructure
17437 for obtaining the boot time, and other packages also supply an
17438 @command{uptime} command, so portable scripts should not rely on its
17439 existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
17443 @node SELinux context
17444 @chapter SELinux context
17446 @cindex SELinux context
17447 @cindex SELinux, context
17448 @cindex commands for SELinux context
17450 This section describes commands for operations with SELinux
17454 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
17455 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
17458 @node chcon invocation
17459 @section @command{chcon}: Change SELinux context of file
17462 @cindex changing security context
17463 @cindex change SELinux context
17465 @command{chcon} changes the SELinux security context of the selected files.
17469 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{context} @var{file}@dots{}
17470 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-l @var{range}]@c
17471 [-t @var{type}] @var{file}@dots{}
17472 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} --reference=@var{rfile} @var{file}@dots{}
17475 Change the SELinux security context of each @var{file} to @var{context}.
17476 With @option{--reference}, change the security context of each @var{file}
17477 to that of @var{rfile}.
17479 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17483 @item --dereference
17484 @opindex --dereference
17485 Do not affect symbolic links but what they refer to; this is the default.
17488 @itemx --no-dereference
17490 @opindex --no-dereference
17491 @cindex no dereference
17492 Affect the symbolic links themselves instead of any referenced file.
17494 @item --reference=@var{rfile}
17495 @opindex --reference
17496 @cindex reference file
17497 Use @var{rfile}'s security context rather than specifying a @var{context} value.
17502 @opindex --recursive
17503 Operate on files and directories recursively.
17505 @item --preserve-root
17506 @opindex --preserve-root
17507 Refuse to operate recursively on the root directory, @file{/},
17508 when used together with the @option{--recursive} option.
17509 @xref{Treating / specially}.
17511 @item --no-preserve-root
17512 @opindex --no-preserve-root
17513 Do not treat the root directory, @file{/}, specially when operating
17514 recursively; this is the default.
17515 @xref{Treating / specially}.
17518 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
17521 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
17524 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
17531 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
17533 @item -u @var{user}
17534 @itemx --user=@var{user}
17537 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
17539 @item -r @var{role}
17540 @itemx --role=@var{role}
17543 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
17545 @item -t @var{type}
17546 @itemx --type=@var{type}
17549 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
17551 @item -l @var{range}
17552 @itemx --range=@var{range}
17555 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
17561 @node runcon invocation
17562 @section @command{runcon}: Run a command in specified SELinux context
17565 @cindex run with security context
17568 @command{runcon} runs file in specified SELinux security context.
17572 runcon @var{context} @var{command} [@var{args}]
17573 runcon [ -c ] [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-t @var{type}]@c
17574 [-l @var{range}] @var{command} [@var{args}]
17577 Run @var{command} with completely-specified @var{context}, or with
17578 current or transitioned security context modified by one or more of @var{level},
17579 @var{role}, @var{type} and @var{user}.
17581 If none of @option{-c}, @option{-t}, @option{-u}, @option{-r}, or @option{-l}
17582 is specified, the first argument is used as the complete context.
17583 Any additional arguments after @var{command}
17584 are interpreted as arguments to the command.
17586 With neither @var{context} nor @var{command}, print the current
17589 @cindex restricted security context
17590 @cindex NO_NEW_PRIVS
17591 The @command{setpriv} command can be used to set the
17592 NO_NEW_PRIVS bit using @command{setpriv --no-new-privs runcon ...},
17593 thus disallowing usage of a security context with more privileges
17594 than the process would normally have.
17596 @command{runcon} accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17604 Compute process transition context before modifying.
17606 @item -u @var{user}
17607 @itemx --user=@var{user}
17610 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
17612 @item -r @var{role}
17613 @itemx --role=@var{role}
17616 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
17618 @item -t @var{type}
17619 @itemx --type=@var{type}
17622 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
17624 @item -l @var{range}
17625 @itemx --range=@var{range}
17628 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
17632 @cindex exit status of @command{runcon}
17636 125 if @command{runcon} itself fails
17637 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
17638 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
17639 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
17642 @node Modified command invocation
17643 @chapter Modified command invocation
17645 @cindex modified command invocation
17646 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
17647 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
17649 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
17650 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
17654 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
17655 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
17656 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
17657 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
17658 * stdbuf invocation:: Modify buffering of standard streams.
17659 * timeout invocation:: Run with time limit.
17663 @node chroot invocation
17664 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
17667 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
17668 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
17670 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
17671 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.@footnote{However,
17672 some systems (e.g., FreeBSD) can be configured to allow certain regular
17673 users to use the @code{chroot} system call, and hence to run this program.
17674 Also, on Cygwin, anyone can run the @command{chroot} command, because the
17675 underlying function is non-privileged due to lack of support in MS-Windows.
17676 Furthermore, the @command{chroot} command avoids the @code{chroot} system call
17677 when @var{newroot} is identical to the old @file{/} directory for consistency
17678 with systems where this is allowed for non-privileged users.}.
17682 chroot @var{option} @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
17683 chroot @var{option}
17686 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
17687 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
17688 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist), then changes the working
17689 directory to @file{/}, and finally runs @var{command} with optional @var{args}.
17690 If @var{command} is not specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL}
17691 environment variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the
17692 @option{-i} option.
17693 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
17694 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
17696 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17697 Options must precede operands.
17701 @item --groups=@var{groups}
17703 Use this option to override the supplementary @var{groups} to be
17704 used by the new process.
17705 The items in the list (names or numeric IDs) must be separated by commas.
17706 Use @samp{--groups=''} to disable the supplementary group look-up
17707 implicit in the @option{--userspec} option.
17709 @item --userspec=@var{user}[:@var{group}]
17710 @opindex --userspec
17711 By default, @var{command} is run with the same credentials
17712 as the invoking process.
17713 Use this option to run it as a different @var{user} and/or with a
17714 different primary @var{group}.
17715 If a @var{user} is specified then the supplementary groups
17716 are set according to the system defined list for that user,
17717 unless overridden with the @option{--groups} option.
17720 @opindex --skip-chdir
17721 Use this option to not change the working directory to @file{/} after changing
17722 the root directory to @var{newroot}, i.e., inside the chroot.
17723 This option is only permitted when @var{newroot} is the old @file{/} directory,
17724 and therefore is mostly useful together with the @option{--groups} and
17725 @option{--userspec} options to retain the previous working directory.
17729 The user and group name look-up performed by the @option{--userspec}
17730 and @option{--groups} options, is done both outside and inside
17731 the chroot, with successful look-ups inside the chroot taking precedence.
17732 If the specified user or group items are intended to represent a numeric ID,
17733 then a name to ID resolving step is avoided by specifying a leading @samp{+}.
17734 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
17736 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
17737 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
17738 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
17739 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
17740 your new root directory.
17742 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
17743 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
17746 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
17749 Then you'll see output like this:
17754 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
17757 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
17758 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
17759 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
17760 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
17761 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
17762 device files), copy them into place, too.
17764 @command{chroot} is installed only on systems that have the
17765 @code{chroot} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
17768 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
17772 125 if @command{chroot} itself fails
17773 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
17774 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
17775 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
17779 @node env invocation
17780 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
17783 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
17784 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
17785 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
17787 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
17790 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
17791 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
17792 env -[v]S'[@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
17793 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]'
17797 @command{env} is commonly used on first line of scripts (shebang line):
17799 #!/usr/bin/env @var{command}
17800 #!/usr/bin/env -[v]S[@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
17801 @var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}
17804 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
17805 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
17806 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
17807 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
17808 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
17809 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
17811 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
17812 characters other than @samp{=} and ASCII NUL.
17813 However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
17814 consist solely of underscores, digits, and ASCII letters,
17815 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
17816 work well with other names.
17819 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
17820 specifies the program to invoke; it is
17821 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
17822 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
17823 The program should not be a special built-in utility
17824 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
17826 Modifications to @env{PATH} take effect prior to searching for
17827 @var{command}. Use caution when reducing @env{PATH}; behavior is
17828 not portable when @env{PATH} is undefined or omits key directories
17829 such as @file{/bin}.
17831 In the rare case that a utility contains a @samp{=} in the name, the
17832 only way to disambiguate it from a variable assignment is to use an
17833 intermediate command for @var{command}, and pass the problematic
17834 program name via @var{args}. For example, if @file{./prog=} is an
17835 executable in the current @env{PATH}:
17838 env prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
17839 env ./prog= true # runs 'true', with ./prog= in environment
17840 env -- prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
17841 env sh -c '\prog= true' # runs 'prog=' with argument 'true'
17842 env sh -c 'exec "$@@"' sh prog= true # also runs 'prog='
17845 @cindex environment, printing
17847 If no command name is specified following the environment
17848 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
17849 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
17851 For some examples, suppose the environment passed to @command{env}
17852 contains @samp{LOGNAME=rms}, @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and
17853 @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}:
17858 Output the current environment.
17860 $ env | LC_ALL=C sort
17863 PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks
17867 Run @command{foo} with a reduced environment, preserving only the
17868 original @env{PATH} to avoid problems in locating @command{foo}.
17870 env - PATH="$PATH" foo
17874 Run @command{foo} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=rms},
17875 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and guarantees
17876 that @command{foo} was found in the file system rather than as a shell
17883 Run @command{nemacs} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=foo},
17884 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and
17885 @samp{DISPLAY=gnu:0}.
17887 env DISPLAY=gnu:0 LOGNAME=foo nemacs
17891 Attempt to run the program @command{/energy/--} (as that is the only
17892 possible path search result); if the command exists, the environment
17893 will contain @samp{LOGNAME=rms} and @samp{PATH=/energy}, and the
17894 arguments will be @samp{e=mc2}, @samp{bar}, and @samp{baz}.
17896 env -u EDITOR PATH=/energy -- e=mc2 bar baz
17902 @subsection General options
17904 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17905 Options must precede operands.
17911 @item -u @var{name}
17912 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
17915 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
17920 @itemx --ignore-environment
17923 @opindex --ignore-environment
17924 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
17927 @itemx --chdir=@var{dir}
17930 Change the working directory to @var{dir} before invoking @var{command}.
17931 This differs from the shell built-in @command{cd} in that it starts
17932 @var{command} as a subprocess rather than altering the shell's own working
17933 directory; this allows it to be chained with other commands that run commands
17934 in a different context. For example:
17937 # Run 'true' with /chroot as its root directory and /srv as its working
17939 chroot /chroot env --chdir=/srv true
17940 # Run 'true' with /build as its working directory, FOO=bar in its
17941 # environment, and a time limit of five seconds.
17942 env --chdir=/build FOO=bar timeout 5 true
17945 @item --default-signal[=@var{sig}]
17946 Unblock and reset signal @var{sig} to its default signal handler.
17947 Without @var{sig} all known signals are unblocked and reset to their defaults.
17948 Multiple signals can be comma-separated. An empty @var{sig} argument is a no-op.
17949 The following command runs @command{seq} with SIGINT and SIGPIPE set to their
17950 default (which is to terminate the program):
17953 env --default-signal=PIPE,INT seq 1000 | head -n1
17956 In the following example, we see how this is not
17957 possible to do with traditional shells.
17958 Here the first trap command sets SIGPIPE to ignore.
17959 The second trap command ostensibly sets it back to its default,
17960 but POSIX mandates that the shell must not change inherited
17961 state of the signal -- so it is a no-op.
17964 trap '' PIPE && sh -c 'trap - PIPE ; seq inf | head -n1'
17967 Using @option{--default-signal=PIPE} we can
17968 ensure the signal handling is set to its default behavior:
17971 trap '' PIPE && sh -c 'env --default-signal=PIPE seq inf | head -n1'
17975 @item --ignore-signal[=@var{sig}]
17976 Ignore signal @var{sig} when running a program. Without @var{sig} all
17977 known signals are set to ignore. Multiple signals can be comma-separated.
17978 An empty @var{sig} argument is a no-op. The following command runs @command{seq}
17979 with SIGINT set to be ignored -- pressing @kbd{Ctrl-C} will not terminate it:
17982 env --ignore-signal=INT seq inf > /dev/null
17985 @samp{SIGCHLD} is special, in that @option{--ignore-signal=CHLD} might have
17986 no effect (POSIX says it's unspecified).
17988 Most operating systems do not allow ignoring @samp{SIGKILL}, @samp{SIGSTOP}
17989 (and possibly other signals). Attempting to ignore these signals will fail.
17991 Multiple (and contradictory) @option{--default-signal=SIG} and
17992 @option{--ignore-signal=SIG} options are processed left-to-right,
17993 with the latter taking precedence. In the following example, @samp{SIGPIPE} is
17994 set to default while @samp{SIGINT} is ignored:
17997 env --default-signal=INT,PIPE --ignore-signal=INT
18000 @item --block-signal[=@var{sig}]
18001 Block signal(s) @var{sig} from being delivered. Without @var{sig} all
18002 known signals are set to blocked. Multiple signals can be comma-separated.
18003 An empty @var{sig} argument is a no-op.
18005 @item --list-signal-handling
18006 List blocked or ignored signals to standard error, before executing a command.
18012 Show verbose information for each processing step.
18015 $ env -v -uTERM A=B uname -s
18024 When combined with @option{-S} it is recommended to list @option{-v}
18025 first, e.g. @command{env -vS'string'}.
18027 @item -S @var{string}
18028 @itemx --split-string=@var{string}
18030 @opindex --split-string
18031 @cindex shebang arguments
18032 @cindex scripts arguments
18033 @cindex env in scripts
18034 process and split @var{string} into separate arguments used to pass
18035 multiple arguments on shebang lines. @command{env} supports FreeBSD's
18036 syntax of several escape sequences and environment variable
18037 expansions. See below for details and examples.
18041 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
18045 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
18046 125 if @command{env} itself fails
18047 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18048 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18049 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18052 @subsection @option{-S}/@option{--split-string} usage in scripts
18054 The @option{-S}/@option{--split-string} option enables use of multiple
18055 arguments on the first line of scripts (the shebang line, @samp{#!}).
18057 When a script's interpreter is in a known location, scripts typically
18058 contain the absolute file name in their first line:
18060 @multitable {Python Script:} {#!/usr/bin/python3}
18061 @item Shell script:
18075 @item Python script:
18084 When a script's interpreter is in a non-standard location
18085 in the @env{PATH} environment variable, it is recommended
18086 to use @command{env} on the first line of the script to
18087 find the executable and run it:
18089 @multitable {Python Script:} {#!/usr/bin/env python3}
18090 @item Shell script:
18093 #!/usr/bin/env bash
18100 #!/usr/bin/env perl
18104 @item Python script:
18107 #!/usr/bin/env python3
18113 Most operating systems (e.g. GNU/Linux, BSDs) treat all text after the
18114 first space as a single argument. When using @command{env} in a script
18115 it is thus not possible to specify multiple arguments.
18117 In the following example:
18119 #!/usr/bin/env perl -T -w
18123 The operating system treats @samp{perl -T -w} as one argument (the
18124 program's name), and executing the script fails with:
18127 /usr/bin/env: 'perl -T -w': No such file or directory
18130 The @option{-S} option instructs @command{env} to split the single string
18131 into multiple arguments. The following example works as expected:
18135 #!/usr/bin/env -S perl -T -w
18138 $ chmod a+x hello.pl
18143 And is equivalent to running @command{perl -T -w hello.pl} on the command line
18146 @unnumberedsubsubsec Testing and troubleshooting
18148 @cindex single quotes, and @command{env -S}
18149 @cindex @command{env -S}, and single quotes
18150 @cindex @option{-S}, env and single quotes
18151 To test @command{env -S} on the command line, use single quotes for the
18152 @option{-S} string to emulate a single parameter. Single quotes are not
18153 needed when using @command{env -S} in a shebang line on the first line of a
18154 script (the operating system already treats it as one argument).
18156 The following command is equivalent to the @file{hello.pl} script above:
18159 $ env -S'perl -T -w' hello.pl
18162 @cindex @command{env -S}, debugging
18163 @cindex debugging, @command{env -S}
18165 To troubleshoot @option{-S} usage add the @option{-v} as the first
18166 argument (before @option{-S}).
18168 Using @option{-vS} on a shebang line in a script:
18171 $ cat hello-debug.pl
18172 #!/usr/bin/env -vS perl -T -w
18175 $ chmod a+x hello-debug.pl
18177 split -S: 'perl -T -w'
18185 arg[3]= './hello-debug.pl'
18189 Using @option{-vS} on the command line prompt (adding single quotes):
18192 $ env -vS'perl -T -w' hello-debug.pl
18193 split -S: 'perl -T -w'
18201 arg[3]= 'hello-debug.pl'
18205 @subsection @option{-S}/@option{--split-string} syntax
18207 @unnumberedsubsubsec Splitting arguments by whitespace
18209 Running @command{env -Sstring} splits the @var{string} into
18210 arguments based on unquoted spaces or tab characters.
18211 (Newlines, carriage returns, vertical tabs and form feeds are treated
18212 like spaces and tabs.)
18214 In the following contrived example the @command{awk} variable
18215 @samp{OFS} will be @code{<space>xyz<space>} as these spaces are inside
18216 double quotes. The other space characters are used as argument separators:
18220 #!/usr/bin/env -S awk -v OFS=" xyz " -f
18221 BEGIN @{print 1,2,3@}
18223 $ chmod a+x one.awk
18228 When using @option{-S} on the command line prompt, remember to add
18229 single quotes around the entire string:
18232 $ env -S'awk -v OFS=" xyz " -f' one.awk
18236 @unnumberedsubsubsec Escape sequences
18238 @command{env} supports several escape sequences. These sequences
18239 are processed when unquoted or inside double quotes (unless otherwise noted).
18240 Single quotes disable escape sequences except @samp{\'} and @samp{\\}.
18242 @multitable @columnfractions .10 .90
18245 @tab Ignore the remaining characters in the string.
18246 Cannot be used inside double quotes.
18249 @tab form-feed character (ASCII 0x0C)
18252 @tab new-line character (ASCII 0x0A)
18255 @tab carriage-return character (ASCII 0x0D)
18258 @tab tab character (ASCII 0x09)
18261 @tab vertical tab character (ASCII 0x0B)
18264 @tab A hash @samp{#} character. Used when a @samp{#} character
18265 is needed as the first character of an argument (see 'comments' section
18269 @tab A dollar-sign character @samp{$}. Unescaped @samp{$} characters
18270 are used to expand environment variables (see 'variables' section below).
18273 @tab Inside double-quotes, replaced with a single space character.
18274 Outside quotes, treated as an argument separator. @samp{\_} can be used
18275 to avoid space characters in a shebang line (see examples below).
18278 @tab A double-quote character.
18281 @tab A single-quote character.
18282 This escape sequence works inside single-quoted strings.
18285 @tab A backslash character.
18286 This escape sequence works inside single-quoted strings.
18290 The following @command{awk} script will use tab character as input and output
18291 field separator (instead of spaces and tabs):
18295 #!/usr/bin/env -S awk -v FS="\t" -v OFS="\t" -f
18299 @unnumberedsubsubsec Comments
18301 The escape sequence @samp{\c} (used outside single/double quotes)
18302 causes @command{env} to ignore the rest of the string.
18304 The @samp{#} character causes @command{env} to ignore the rest of
18305 the string when it appears as the first character of an argument.
18306 Use @samp{\#} to reverse this behavior.
18309 $ env -S'printf %s\n A B C'
18314 $ env -S'printf %s\n A# B C'
18319 $ env -S'printf %s\n A #B C'
18322 $ env -S'printf %s\n A \#B C'
18327 $ env -S'printf %s\n A\cB C'
18331 The above examples use single quotes as they are executed
18332 on the command-line.
18336 @unnumberedsubsubsec Environment variable expansion
18338 The pattern @samp{$@{VARNAME@}} is used to substitute a value from
18339 the environment variable. The pattern must include the curly braces
18340 (@samp{@{},@samp{@}}). Without them @command{env} will reject the string.
18341 Special shell variables (such as @samp{$@@}, @samp{$*}, @samp{$$}) are
18344 If the environment variable is empty or not set, the pattern will be replaced
18345 by an empty string. The value of @samp{$@{VARNAME@}} will be that of
18346 the executed @command{env}, before any modifications using
18347 @option{-i}/@option{--ignore-environment}/@option{-u}/@option{--unset} or
18348 setting new values using @samp{VAR=VALUE}.
18350 The following python script prepends @file{/opt/custom/modules} to the python
18351 module search path environment variable (@samp{PYTHONPATH}):
18355 #!/usr/bin/env -S PYTHONPATH=/opt/custom/modules/:$@{PYTHONPATH@} python
18360 The expansion of @samp{$@{PYTHONPATH@}} is performed by @command{env},
18361 not by a shell. If the curly braces are omitted, @command{env} will fail:
18365 #!/usr/bin/env -S PYTHONPATH=/opt/custom/modules/:$PYTHONPATH python
18369 $ chmod a+x custom.py
18371 /usr/bin/env: only $@{VARNAME@} expansion is supported, error at: $PYTHONPATH @c
18375 Environment variable expansion happens before clearing the environment
18376 (with @option{-i}) or unsetting specific variables (with @option{-u}):
18379 $ env -S'-i OLDUSER=$@{USER@} env'
18383 Use @option{-v} to diagnose the operations step-by-step:
18386 $ env -vS'-i OLDUSER=$@{USER@} env'
18387 expanding $@{USER@} into 'gordon'
18388 split -S: '-i OLDUSER=$@{USER@} env'
18393 setenv: OLDUSER=gordon
18401 @node nice invocation
18402 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
18406 @cindex scheduling, affecting
18407 @cindex appropriate privileges
18409 @command{nice} prints a process's @dfn{niceness}, or runs
18410 a command with modified niceness. @dfn{niceness} affects how
18411 favorably the process is scheduled in the system.
18415 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
18418 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
18419 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
18420 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
18422 Niceness values range at least from @minus{}20 (process has high priority
18423 and gets more resources, thus slowing down other processes) through 19
18424 (process has lower priority and runs slowly itself, but has less impact
18425 on the speed of other running processes). Some systems
18426 may have a wider range of niceness values; conversely, other systems may
18427 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
18428 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
18429 minimum or maximum supported value.
18431 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
18432 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
18433 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
18434 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
18435 terminology, POSIX defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
18436 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the non-negative difference
18437 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
18438 conforms to POSIX, its documentation and diagnostics use the
18439 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
18441 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
18442 built-in utilities}).
18444 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{nice}
18446 To change the @dfn{niceness} of an existing process,
18447 one needs to use the @command{renice} command.
18449 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18450 Options must precede operands.
18453 @item -n @var{adjustment}
18454 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
18456 @opindex --adjustment
18457 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
18458 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
18459 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
18462 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
18463 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
18464 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
18468 @command{nice} is installed only on systems that have the POSIX
18469 @code{setpriority} function, so portable scripts should not rely on
18470 its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
18472 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
18476 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
18477 125 if @command{nice} itself fails
18478 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18479 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18480 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18483 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
18486 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
18489 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
18490 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
18492 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
18503 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
18504 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
18505 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
18509 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
18513 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
18514 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
18517 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
18521 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
18525 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
18527 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
18532 @node nohup invocation
18533 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
18536 @cindex hangups, immunity to
18537 @cindex immunity to hangups
18538 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
18541 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
18542 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
18546 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
18549 If standard input is a terminal, redirect it so that terminal sessions
18550 do not mistakenly consider the terminal to be used by the command.
18551 Make the substitute file descriptor unreadable, so that commands that
18552 mistakenly attempt to read from standard input can report an error.
18553 This redirection is a GNU extension; programs intended to be portable
18554 to non-GNU hosts can use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
18555 0>/dev/null} instead.
18558 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
18559 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
18560 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
18561 command is not run.
18562 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
18563 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
18564 regardless of the current umask settings.
18566 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
18567 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
18568 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
18569 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
18570 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
18572 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
18573 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
18577 nohup make > make.log
18580 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
18581 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
18582 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
18583 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
18584 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
18586 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
18587 built-in utilities}).
18589 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
18590 options}. Options must precede operands.
18592 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
18596 125 if @command{nohup} itself fails, and @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set
18597 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18598 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18599 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18602 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, internal failures give status 127
18606 @node stdbuf invocation
18607 @section @command{stdbuf}: Run a command with modified I/O stream buffering
18610 @cindex standard streams, buffering
18611 @cindex line buffered
18613 @command{stdbuf} allows one to modify the buffering operations of the
18614 three standard I/O streams associated with a program. Synopsis:
18617 stdbuf @var{option}@dots{} @var{command}
18620 @var{command} must start with the name of a program that
18623 uses the ISO C @code{FILE} streams for input/output, and
18626 does not adjust the buffering of its standard streams.
18629 Not every command operates in this way.
18630 For example, @command{dd} does not use @code{FILE} streams,
18631 and @command{tee} adjusts its streams' buffering.
18633 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
18636 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18640 @item -i @var{mode}
18641 @itemx --input=@var{mode}
18644 Adjust the standard input stream buffering.
18646 @item -o @var{mode}
18647 @itemx --output=@var{mode}
18650 Adjust the standard output stream buffering.
18652 @item -e @var{mode}
18653 @itemx --error=@var{mode}
18656 Adjust the standard error stream buffering.
18660 The @var{mode} can be specified as follows:
18665 Set the stream to line buffered mode.
18666 In this mode data is coalesced until a newline is output or
18667 input is read from any stream attached to a terminal device.
18668 This option is invalid with standard input.
18671 Disable buffering of the selected stream.
18672 In this mode, data is output immediately and only the
18673 amount of data requested is read from input.
18674 Disabling buffering for input does not necessarily influence the responsiveness
18675 or blocking behavior of the stream input functions.
18676 For example, @code{fread} will still block until @code{EOF} or error
18677 or the amount requested is read,
18678 even if the underlying @code{read} returns less data than requested.
18681 Specify the size of the buffer to use in fully buffered mode.
18682 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
18686 @command{stdbuf} is installed only on platforms that use the
18687 Executable and Linkable Format (ELF) and support the
18688 @code{constructor} attribute, so portable scripts should not rely on
18691 @cindex exit status of @command{stdbuf}
18695 125 if @command{stdbuf} itself fails
18696 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18697 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18698 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18702 @node timeout invocation
18703 @section @command{timeout}: Run a command with a time limit
18707 @cindex run commands with bounded time
18709 @command{timeout} runs the given @var{command} and kills it if it is
18710 still running after the specified time interval. Synopsis:
18713 timeout [@var{option}] @var{duration} @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
18716 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
18717 built-in utilities}).
18719 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18720 Options must precede operands.
18723 @item --preserve-status
18724 @opindex --preserve-status
18725 Return the exit status of the managed @var{command} on timeout, rather than
18726 a specific exit status indicating a timeout. This is useful if the
18727 managed @var{command} supports running for an indeterminate amount of time.
18730 @opindex --foreground
18731 Don't create a separate background program group, so that
18732 the managed @var{command} can use the foreground TTY normally.
18733 This is needed to support two situations when timing out commands,
18734 when not invoking @command{timeout} from an interactive shell.
18737 @var{command} is interactive and needs to read from the terminal for example
18739 the user wants to support sending signals directly to @var{command}
18740 from the terminal (like Ctrl-C for example)
18743 In this mode of operation, any children of @var{command}
18744 will not be timed out. Also SIGCONT will not be sent to @var{command},
18745 as it's generally not needed with foreground processes, and can
18746 cause intermittent signal delivery issues with programs that are monitors
18747 themselves (like GDB for example).
18749 @item -k @var{duration}
18750 @itemx --kill-after=@var{duration}
18752 @opindex --kill-after
18753 Ensure the monitored @var{command} is killed by also sending a @samp{KILL}
18756 The specified @var{duration} starts from the point in time when
18757 @command{timeout} sends the initial signal to @var{command}, i.e.,
18758 not from the beginning when the @var{command} is started.
18760 This option has no effect if either the main @var{duration}
18761 of the @command{timeout} command, or the @var{duration} specified
18762 to this option, is 0.
18764 This option may be useful if the selected signal did not kill the @var{command},
18765 either because the signal was blocked or ignored, or if the @var{command} takes
18766 too long (e.g. for cleanup work) to terminate itself within a certain amount
18769 @item -s @var{signal}
18770 @itemx --signal=@var{signal}
18773 Send this @var{signal} to @var{command} on timeout, rather than the
18774 default @samp{TERM} signal. @var{signal} may be a name like @samp{HUP}
18775 or a number. @xref{Signal specifications}.
18781 Diagnose to standard error, any signal sent upon timeout.
18785 @var{duration} is a floating point number in either the current or the
18786 C locale (@pxref{Floating point}) followed by an optional unit:
18788 @samp{s} for seconds (the default)
18789 @samp{m} for minutes
18793 A duration of 0 disables the associated timeout.
18794 The actual timeout duration is dependent on system conditions,
18795 which should be especially considered when specifying sub-second timeouts.
18797 @cindex exit status of @command{timeout}
18801 124 if @var{command} times out, and @option{--preserve-status} is not specified
18802 125 if @command{timeout} itself fails
18803 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18804 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18805 137 if @var{command} or @command{timeout} is sent the KILL(9) signal (128+9)
18806 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18809 In the case of the @samp{KILL(9)} signal, @command{timeout} returns with
18810 exit status 137, regardless of whether that signal is sent to @var{command}
18811 or to @command{timeout} itself, i.e., these cases cannot be distinguished.
18812 In the latter case, the @var{command} process may still be alive after
18813 @command{timeout} has forcefully been terminated.
18818 # Send the default TERM signal after 20s to a short-living 'sleep 1'.
18819 # As that terminates long before the given duration, 'timeout' returns
18820 # with the same exit status as the command, 0 in this case.
18823 # Send the INT signal after 5s to the 'sleep' command. Returns after
18824 # 5 seconds with exit status 124 to indicate the sending of the signal.
18825 timeout -s INT 5 sleep 20
18827 # Likewise, but the command ignoring the INT signal due to being started
18828 # via 'env --ignore-signal'. Thus, 'sleep' terminates regularly after
18829 # the full 20 seconds, still 'timeout' returns with exit status 124.
18830 timeout -s INT 5s env --ignore-signal=INT sleep 20
18832 # Likewise, but sending the KILL signal 3 seconds after the initial
18833 # INT signal. Hence, 'sleep' is forcefully terminated after about
18834 # 8 seconds (5+3), and 'timeout' returns with an exit status of 137.
18835 timeout -s INT -k 3s 5s env --ignore-signal=INT sleep 20
18838 @node Process control
18839 @chapter Process control
18841 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
18842 @cindex commands for controlling processes
18845 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
18849 @node kill invocation
18850 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
18853 @cindex send a signal to processes
18855 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
18856 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
18857 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
18860 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
18861 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
18864 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{kill}
18866 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
18867 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
18868 is @samp{TERM}@. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
18869 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
18870 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
18872 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
18873 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
18874 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
18875 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
18876 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
18877 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
18878 value of @var{pid}.
18880 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
18881 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
18884 If a negative @var{pid} argument is desired as the first one, it
18885 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
18886 POSIX, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
18887 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
18896 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
18897 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
18899 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
18900 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
18901 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
18902 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
18903 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
18904 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
18905 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
18906 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
18907 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
18908 and if there is no output error.
18910 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
18911 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
18913 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
18914 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
18915 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
18916 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
18917 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
18918 ambiguity with lower case option letters.
18919 @xref{Signal specifications}, for a list of supported
18920 signal names and numbers.
18925 @cindex delaying commands
18926 @cindex commands for delaying
18928 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
18931 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
18935 @node sleep invocation
18936 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
18939 @cindex delay for a specified time
18941 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
18942 the values of the command line arguments.
18946 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
18950 Each argument is a non-negative number followed by an optional unit; the default
18951 is seconds. The units are:
18964 Although portable POSIX scripts must give @command{sleep} a single
18965 non-negative integer argument without a suffix, GNU @command{sleep}
18966 also accepts two or more arguments, unit suffixes, and floating-point
18967 numbers in either the current or the C locale. @xref{Floating point}.
18969 For instance, the following could be used to @command{sleep} for
18970 1 second, 234 milli-, 567 micro- and 890 nanoseconds:
18973 sleep 1234e-3 567.89e-6
18976 Also one could sleep indefinitely like:
18982 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
18985 @c sleep is a shell built-in at least with Solaris 11's /bin/sh
18986 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{sleep}
18991 @node Numeric operations
18992 @chapter Numeric operations
18994 @cindex numeric operations
18995 These programs do numerically-related operations.
18998 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
18999 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers.
19000 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
19004 @node factor invocation
19005 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
19008 @cindex prime factors
19010 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopsis:
19013 factor [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{number}]@dots{}
19016 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
19017 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
19019 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
19025 @opindex --exponents
19026 print factors in the form @math{p^e}, rather than repeating
19027 the prime @samp{p}, @samp{e} times. If the exponent @samp{e} is 1,
19028 then it is omitted.
19031 $ factor --exponents 3000
19036 If the number to be factored is small (less than @math{2^{127}} on
19037 typical machines), @command{factor} uses a faster algorithm.
19038 For example, on a circa-2017 Intel Xeon Silver 4116, factoring the
19039 product of the eighth and ninth Mersenne primes (approximately
19040 @math{2^{92}}) takes about 4 ms of CPU time:
19043 $ M8=$(echo 2^31-1 | bc)
19044 $ M9=$(echo 2^61-1 | bc)
19045 $ n=$(echo "$M8 * $M9" | bc)
19046 $ bash -c "time factor $n"
19047 4951760154835678088235319297: 2147483647 2305843009213693951
19054 For larger numbers, @command{factor} uses a slower algorithm. On the
19055 same platform, factoring the eighth Fermat number @math{2^{256} + 1}
19056 takes about 14 seconds, and the slower algorithm would have taken
19057 about 750 ms to factor @math{2^{127} - 3} instead of the 50 ms needed by
19058 the faster algorithm.
19060 Factoring large numbers is, in general, hard. The Pollard-Brent rho
19061 algorithm used by @command{factor} is particularly effective for
19062 numbers with relatively small factors. If you wish to factor large
19063 numbers which do not have small factors (for example, numbers which
19064 are the product of two large primes), other methods are far better.
19069 @node numfmt invocation
19070 @section @command{numfmt}: Reformat numbers
19074 @command{numfmt} reads numbers in various representations and reformats them
19075 as requested. The most common usage is converting numbers to/from @emph{human}
19076 representation (e.g. @samp{4G} @expansion{} @samp{4,000,000,000}).
19079 numfmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{number}]
19082 @command{numfmt} converts each @var{number} on the command-line according to the
19083 specified options (see below). If no @var{number}s are given, it reads numbers
19084 from standard input. @command{numfmt} can optionally extract numbers from
19085 specific columns, maintaining proper line padding and alignment.
19089 See @option{--invalid} for additional information regarding exit status.
19091 @subsection General options
19093 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
19099 Print (to standard error) warning messages about possible erroneous usage.
19102 @itemx --delimiter=@var{d}
19104 @opindex --delimiter
19105 Use the character @var{d} as input field separator (default: whitespace).
19106 Using non-default delimiter turns off automatic padding.
19108 @item --field=@var{fields}
19110 Convert the number in input field @var{fields} (default: 1).
19111 @var{fields} supports @command{cut} style field ranges:
19114 N N'th field, counted from 1
19115 N- from N'th field, to end of line
19116 N-M from N'th to M'th field (inclusive)
19117 -M from first to M'th field (inclusive)
19122 @item --format=@var{format}
19124 Use printf-style floating FORMAT string. The @var{format} string must contain
19125 one @samp{%f} directive, optionally with @samp{'}, @samp{-}, @samp{0}, width
19126 or precision modifiers. The @samp{'} modifier will enable @option{--grouping},
19127 the @samp{-} modifier will enable left-aligned @option{--padding} and the width
19128 modifier will enable right-aligned @option{--padding}. The @samp{0} width
19129 modifier (without the @samp{-} modifier) will generate leading zeros on the
19130 number, up to the specified width. A precision specification like @samp{%.1f}
19131 will override the precision determined from the input data or set due to
19132 @option{--to} option auto scaling.
19134 @item --from=@var{unit}
19136 Auto-scales input numbers according to @var{unit}. See UNITS below.
19137 The default is no scaling, meaning suffixes (e.g. @samp{M}, @samp{G}) will
19140 @item --from-unit=@var{n}
19141 @opindex --from-unit
19142 Specify the input unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
19143 the input numbers represent other units (e.g. if the input number @samp{10}
19144 represents 10 units of 512 bytes, use @samp{--from-unit=512}).
19145 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
19148 @opindex --grouping
19149 Group digits in output numbers according to the current locale's grouping rules
19150 (e.g @emph{Thousands Separator} character, commonly @samp{.} (dot) or @samp{,}
19151 comma). This option has no effect in @samp{POSIX/C} locale.
19153 @item --header[=@var{n}]
19155 @opindex --header=N
19156 Print the first @var{n} (default: 1) lines without any conversion.
19158 @item --invalid=@var{mode}
19160 The default action on input errors is to exit immediately with status code 2.
19161 @option{--invalid=@samp{abort}} explicitly specifies this default mode.
19162 With a @var{mode} of @samp{fail}, print a warning for @emph{each} conversion
19163 error, and exit with status 2. With a @var{mode} of @samp{warn}, exit with
19164 status 0, even in the presence of conversion errors, and with a @var{mode} of
19165 @samp{ignore} do not even print diagnostics.
19167 @item --padding=@var{n}
19169 Pad the output numbers to @var{n} characters, by adding spaces. If @var{n} is
19170 a positive number, numbers will be right-aligned. If @var{n} is a negative
19171 number, numbers will be left-aligned. By default, numbers are automatically
19172 aligned based on the input line's width (only with the default delimiter).
19174 @item --round=@var{method}
19176 @opindex --round=up
19177 @opindex --round=down
19178 @opindex --round=from-zero
19179 @opindex --round=towards-zero
19180 @opindex --round=nearest
19181 When converting number representations, round the number according to
19182 @var{method}, which can be @samp{up}, @samp{down},
19183 @samp{from-zero} (the default), @samp{towards-zero}, @samp{nearest}.
19185 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
19187 Add @samp{SUFFIX} to the output numbers, and accept optional @samp{SUFFIX} in
19190 @item --to=@var{unit}
19192 Auto-scales output numbers according to @var{unit}. See @emph{Units} below.
19193 The default is no scaling, meaning all the digits of the number are printed.
19195 @item --to-unit=@var{n}
19197 Specify the output unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
19198 the output numbers represent other units (e.g. to represent @samp{4,000,000}
19199 bytes in blocks of 1kB, use @samp{--to=si --to-unit=1000}).
19200 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
19203 @newlineFieldSeparator
19207 @subsection Possible @var{unit}s:
19209 The following are the possible @var{unit} options with @option{--from=UNITS} and
19210 @option{--to=UNITS}:
19215 No scaling is performed. For input numbers, no suffixes are accepted, and any
19216 trailing characters following the number will trigger an error. For output
19217 numbers, all digits of the numbers will be printed.
19220 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International System of Units (SI)}
19222 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
19223 For output numbers, values larger than 1000 will be rounded, and printed with
19224 one of the following suffixes:
19227 @samp{K} => @math{1000^1 = 10^3} (Kilo) (uppercase accepted on input)
19228 @samp{k} => @math{1000^1 = 10^3} (Kilo) (lowercase used on output)
19229 @samp{M} => @math{1000^2 = 10^6} (Mega)
19230 @samp{G} => @math{1000^3 = 10^9} (Giga)
19231 @samp{T} => @math{1000^4 = 10^{12}} (Tera)
19232 @samp{P} => @math{1000^5 = 10^{15}} (Peta)
19233 @samp{E} => @math{1000^6 = 10^{18}} (Exa)
19234 @samp{Z} => @math{1000^7 = 10^{21}} (Zetta)
19235 @samp{Y} => @math{1000^8 = 10^{24}} (Yotta)
19236 @samp{R} => @math{1000^9 = 10^{27}} (Ronna)
19237 @samp{Q} => @math{1000^{10} = 10^{30}} (Quetta)
19241 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
19242 Commission (IEC)} standard.
19243 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
19244 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
19245 one of the following suffixes:
19248 @samp{K} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi) (uppercase used on output)
19249 @samp{k} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi) (lowercase accepted on input)
19250 @samp{M} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
19251 @samp{G} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
19252 @samp{T} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
19253 @samp{P} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
19254 @samp{E} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
19255 @samp{Z} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
19256 @samp{Y} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
19257 @samp{R} => @math{1024^9 = 2^{90}} (Robi)
19258 @samp{Q} => @math{1024^{10} = 2^{100}} (Quebi)
19261 The @option{iec} option uses a single letter suffix (e.g. @samp{G}), which is
19262 not fully standard, as the @emph{iec} standard recommends a two-letter symbol
19263 (e.g @samp{Gi}) -- but in practice, this method is common. Compare with
19264 the @option{iec-i} option.
19267 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
19268 Commission (IEC)} standard.
19269 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
19270 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
19271 one of the following suffixes:
19274 @samp{Ki} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi) (uppercase used on output)
19275 @samp{ki} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi) (lowercase accepted on input)
19276 @samp{Mi} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
19277 @samp{Gi} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
19278 @samp{Ti} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
19279 @samp{Pi} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
19280 @samp{Ei} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
19281 @samp{Zi} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
19282 @samp{Yi} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
19283 @samp{Ri} => @math{1024^9 = 2^{90}} (Robi)
19284 @samp{Qi} => @math{1024^{10} = 2^{100}} (Quebi)
19287 The @option{iec-i} option uses a two-letter suffix symbol (e.g. @samp{Gi}),
19288 as the @emph{iec} standard recommends, but this is not always common in
19289 practice. Compare with the @option{iec} option.
19292 @samp{auto} can only be used with @option{--from}. With this method, numbers
19293 with single-letter suffixes like @samp{K}
19294 suffixes are interpreted as @emph{SI} values, and numbers with
19295 two-letter suffixes like @samp{Ki}
19296 are interpreted as @emph{IEC} values.
19300 @subsection Examples of using @command{numfmt}
19302 Converting a single number from/to @emph{human} representation:
19304 $ numfmt --to=si 500000
19307 $ numfmt --to=iec 500000
19310 $ numfmt --to=iec-i 500000
19313 $ numfmt --from=si 1M
19316 $ numfmt --from=iec 1M
19319 # with '--from=auto', M=Mega, Mi=Mebi
19320 $ numfmt --from=auto 1M
19322 $ numfmt --from=auto 1Mi
19326 Converting from @samp{SI} to @samp{IEC} scales (e.g. when a drive's capacity is
19327 advertised as @samp{1TB}, while checking the drive's capacity gives lower
19331 $ numfmt --from=si --to=iec 1T
19335 With both input and output scales specified,
19336 the largest defined prefixes are supported:
19339 $ numfmt --from=si --to=iec-i 2000R
19343 Converting a single field from an input file / piped input (these contrived
19344 examples are for demonstration purposes only, as both @command{ls} and
19345 @command{df} support the @option{--human-readable} option to
19346 output sizes in human-readable format):
19349 # Third field (file size) will be shown in SI representation
19350 $ ls -log | numfmt --field 3 --header --to=si | head -n4
19351 -rw-r--r-- 1 94k Aug 23 2011 ABOUT-NLS
19352 -rw-r--r-- 1 3.7k Jan 7 16:15 AUTHORS
19353 -rw-r--r-- 1 36k Jun 1 2011 COPYING
19354 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jan 7 15:15 ChangeLog
19356 # Second field (size) will be shown in IEC representation
19357 $ df --block-size=1 | numfmt --field 2 --header --to=iec | head -n4
19358 File system 1B-blocks Used Available Use% Mounted on
19359 rootfs 132G 104741408 26554036 80% /
19360 tmpfs 794M 7580 804960 1% /run/shm
19361 /dev/sdb1 694G 651424756 46074696 94% /home
19365 Output can be tweaked using @option{--padding} or @option{--format}:
19368 # Pad to 10 characters, right-aligned
19369 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=10
19375 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned
19376 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=-10
19382 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
19383 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --format="%10f"
19389 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
19390 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding="%-10f"
19397 With locales that support grouping digits, using @option{--grouping} or
19398 @option{--format} enables grouping. In @samp{POSIX} locale, grouping is
19402 $ LC_ALL=C numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
19405 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
19408 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
19411 $ LC_ALL=C numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
19414 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
19417 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'-15f==" 2G
19420 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
19421 == 2,14,74,83,648==
19425 @node seq invocation
19426 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
19429 @cindex numeric sequences
19430 @cindex sequence of numbers
19432 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
19435 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
19436 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
19437 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
19440 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
19441 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
19442 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
19443 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
19444 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
19445 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
19446 The sequence of numbers ends when the sum of the current number and
19447 @var{increment} would become greater than @var{last},
19448 so @code{seq 1 10 10} only produces @samp{1}.
19449 @var{increment} must not be @samp{0}; use the tool @command{yes} to get
19450 repeated output of a constant number.
19451 @var{first}, @var{increment} and @var{last} must not be @code{NaN},
19452 but @code{inf} is supported.
19453 Floating-point numbers may be specified in either the current or
19454 the C locale. @xref{Floating point}.
19456 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
19457 Options must precede operands.
19460 @item -f @var{format}
19461 @itemx --format=@var{format}
19464 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
19465 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
19466 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
19467 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
19468 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}@.
19469 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
19470 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
19471 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
19472 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
19473 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
19474 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
19476 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
19477 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
19478 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
19479 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
19480 the default format is @samp{%g}.
19482 @item -s @var{string}
19483 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
19485 @opindex --separator
19486 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
19487 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
19488 The output always terminates with a newline.
19491 @itemx --equal-width
19493 @opindex --equal-width
19494 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
19495 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
19496 decimal representation.
19497 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
19501 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
19504 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
19510 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
19511 to perform the conversion:
19514 $ printf '%x\n' $(seq 1048575 1024 1050623)
19520 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
19521 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
19524 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
19530 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
19533 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
19534 at least @math{2^{53}}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
19535 differ depending on your floating-point implementation.
19536 @xref{Floating point}. A common
19537 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @math{2^{64}},
19538 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
19541 $ seq 50000000000000000000 2 50000000000000000004
19542 50000000000000000000
19543 50000000000000000000
19544 50000000000000000004
19547 However, when limited to non-negative whole numbers,
19548 an increment of less than 200, and no format-specifying option,
19549 seq can print arbitrarily large numbers.
19550 Therefore @command{seq inf} can be used to
19551 generate an infinite sequence of numbers.
19553 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
19554 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
19555 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
19556 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
19559 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
19562 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
19567 @node File permissions
19568 @chapter File permissions
19572 @node File timestamps
19573 @chapter File timestamps
19579 Standard POSIX files have three timestamps: the access timestamp
19580 (atime) of the last read, the modification timestamp (mtime) of the
19581 last write, and the status change timestamp (ctime) of the last change
19582 to the file's meta-information. Some file systems support a
19583 fourth time: the birth timestamp (birthtime) of when the file was
19584 created; by definition, birthtime never changes.
19586 One common example of a ctime change is when the permissions of a file
19587 change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so atime
19588 doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime doesn't
19589 change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed, and this
19590 must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field. This is
19591 necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a fresh
19592 copy of the file, including the new permissions value. Another
19593 operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting the others is
19596 Naively, a file's atime, mtime, and ctime are set to the current time
19597 whenever you read, write, or change the attributes of the file
19598 respectively, and searching a directory counts as reading it. A
19599 file's atime and mtime can also be set directly, via the
19600 @command{touch} command (@pxref{touch invocation}). In practice,
19601 though, timestamps are not updated quite that way.
19603 For efficiency reasons, many systems are lazy about updating atimes:
19604 when a program accesses a file, they may delay updating the file's
19605 atime, or may not update the file's atime if the file has been
19606 accessed recently, or may not update the atime at all. Similar
19607 laziness, though typically not quite so extreme, applies to mtimes and
19610 Some systems emulate timestamps instead of supporting them directly,
19611 and these emulations may disagree with the naive interpretation. For
19612 example, a system may fake an atime or ctime by using the mtime.
19615 The determination of what time is ``current'' depends on the
19616 platform. Platforms with network file systems often use different
19617 clocks for the operating system and for file systems; because
19618 updates typically uses file systems' clocks by default, clock
19619 skew can cause the resulting file timestamps to appear to be in a
19620 program's ``future'' or ``past''.
19622 @cindex file timestamp resolution
19623 When the system updates a file timestamp to a desired time @var{t}
19624 (which is either the current time, or a time specified via the
19625 @command{touch} command), there are several reasons the file's
19626 timestamp may be set to a value that differs from @var{t}. First,
19627 @var{t} may have a higher resolution than supported. Second, a file
19628 system may use different resolutions for different types of times.
19629 Third, file timestamps may use a different resolution than operating
19630 system timestamps. Fourth, the operating system primitives used to
19631 update timestamps may employ yet a different resolution. For example,
19632 in theory a file system might use 10-microsecond resolution for access
19633 timestamp and 100-nanosecond resolution for modification timestamp, and the
19634 operating system might use nanosecond resolution for the current time
19635 and microsecond resolution for the primitive that @command{touch} uses
19636 to set a file's timestamp to an arbitrary value.
19639 @include parse-datetime.texi
19641 @include sort-version.texi
19645 @node Opening the software toolbox
19646 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
19648 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
19649 @uref{https://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
19650 @cite{What's GNU@?} column of the June 1994 @cite{Linux Journal}}.
19651 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
19654 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
19655 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
19656 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
19657 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
19658 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
19659 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
19660 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
19664 @node Toolbox introduction
19665 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
19667 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
19668 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system
19670 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
19671 of program development and usage.
19673 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
19674 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which GNU/Linux and GNU are
19675 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
19676 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
19677 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
19678 for solving many kinds of problems.
19680 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
19681 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
19682 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
19683 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
19684 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
19686 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
19687 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
19688 tools -- a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
19689 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
19690 with the handle of his screwdriver.
19692 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
19693 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
19694 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
19699 difficult to write,
19702 difficult to maintain and
19706 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
19709 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
19710 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
19711 simpler to design, write, and get right -- they only do one thing.
19713 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
19714 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
19715 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
19716 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
19717 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
19718 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
19719 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
19720 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
19721 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
19723 @node I/O redirection
19724 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
19726 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
19727 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
19728 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
19729 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
19730 data source is a regular file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
19731 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
19732 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
19733 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
19734 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
19737 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
19740 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
19743 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
19744 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
19745 it is in the desired form.
19747 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
19748 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
19749 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
19750 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
19751 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
19752 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
19753 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
19754 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
19755 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
19757 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
19758 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
19759 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
19760 lines delimited by the ASCII LF (Line Feed) character,
19761 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
19762 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
19763 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
19764 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
19765 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
19766 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
19767 data with a text editor.)
19769 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
19770 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
19771 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
19772 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
19773 for the full story.
19775 @node The who command
19776 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
19778 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
19779 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
19780 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
19785 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
19786 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
19787 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
19788 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
19791 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
19792 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
19793 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
19794 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
19795 but the data is not all that exciting.
19797 @node The cut command
19798 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
19800 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
19801 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
19802 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
19803 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
19807 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
19810 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
19813 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
19814 @print{} root:Operator
19816 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
19817 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
19821 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
19822 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
19823 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
19824 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
19826 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
19837 @node The sort command
19838 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
19840 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
19841 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
19842 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
19845 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
19846 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
19847 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
19848 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
19849 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
19852 @node The uniq command
19853 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
19855 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
19856 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
19857 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
19858 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
19859 standard input. It prints only one
19860 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
19861 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
19862 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
19865 @node Putting the tools together
19866 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
19868 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
19869 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a
19871 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
19872 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
19875 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
19876 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
19877 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
19878 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
19879 by generating just a list of logged on users:
19889 Next, sort the list:
19892 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
19899 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
19902 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
19908 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
19909 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
19910 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
19912 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it
19914 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
19915 or @code{root}, prompt):
19918 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
19919 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
19921 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
19924 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
19925 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
19926 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
19927 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
19928 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
19929 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
19930 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
19933 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
19934 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
19935 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
19937 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
19938 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
19939 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
19941 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
19942 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
19943 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
19946 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
19947 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
19949 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
19950 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
19951 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
19955 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
19956 @print{} this example has mixed case!
19959 There are several options of interest:
19963 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
19964 operations apply to characters not in the given set
19967 delete characters in the first set from the output
19970 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
19973 We will be using all three options in a moment.
19975 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
19976 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
19977 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
19978 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
19979 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
19980 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
19981 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
20003 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
20004 instead of a regular file.
20006 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
20007 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
20010 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
20011 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
20014 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
20017 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
20018 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
20022 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
20025 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
20026 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
20027 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
20028 be left alone. (The ASCII tab character should also be included for
20029 good measure in a production script.)
20031 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
20032 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
20033 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
20034 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
20037 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
20038 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
20041 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
20042 multiple newline characters in the output into just one, removing
20043 blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
20044 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
20045 typing in all of a command.)
20047 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
20048 case. We're ready to count each word:
20051 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
20052 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
20055 At this point, the data might look something like this:
20068 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
20069 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
20070 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
20074 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
20077 reverse the order of the sort
20080 The final pipeline looks like this:
20083 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
20084 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
20093 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
20094 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
20095 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
20096 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
20098 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
20099 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
20100 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
20101 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
20102 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/share/dict/words}.
20104 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
20105 a sorted list of words, one per line:
20108 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
20109 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
20112 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
20113 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
20114 Unfortunately @command{comm} operates on sorted input and
20115 @file{/usr/share/dict/words} is not sorted the way that @command{sort}
20116 and @command{comm} normally use, so we first create a properly-sorted
20117 copy of the dictionary and then run a pipeline that uses the copy.
20120 $ sort /usr/share/dict/words > sorted-words
20121 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
20122 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
20123 > comm -23 - sorted-words
20126 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
20127 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
20128 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
20129 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
20130 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
20131 spelling checker on Unix.
20133 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
20137 search files for text that matches a regular expression
20140 count lines, words, characters
20143 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
20146 the stream editor, an advanced tool
20149 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
20152 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
20153 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
20154 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
20155 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
20161 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
20164 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
20165 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
20166 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
20169 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
20170 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
20173 Let someone else do the hard part.
20176 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
20177 appropriate tool, build one.
20180 All the programs discussed are available as described in
20181 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/software/coreutils/coreutils.html,
20182 GNU core utilities}.
20184 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
20185 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
20186 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
20187 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
20188 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
20189 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
20190 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
20191 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
20192 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
20195 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
20196 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
20197 still in print and are well worth
20198 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
20199 how I view programming.
20201 The programs in both books are available from
20202 @uref{https://www.cs.princeton.edu/~bwk/, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
20203 For a number of years, there was an active
20204 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
20205 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
20206 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
20207 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
20209 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
20210 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
20211 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
20212 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
20213 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
20215 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
20216 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
20218 @node GNU Free Documentation License
20219 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
20223 @node Concept index
20230 @c Local variables:
20231 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32